WO2020213691A1 - フルオロポリマー粉末の製造方法 - Google Patents

フルオロポリマー粉末の製造方法 Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2020213691A1
WO2020213691A1 PCT/JP2020/016766 JP2020016766W WO2020213691A1 WO 2020213691 A1 WO2020213691 A1 WO 2020213691A1 JP 2020016766 W JP2020016766 W JP 2020016766W WO 2020213691 A1 WO2020213691 A1 WO 2020213691A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
group
fluoropolymer
ppm
less
general formula
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Ceased
Application number
PCT/JP2020/016766
Other languages
English (en)
French (fr)
Japanese (ja)
Inventor
千亜紀 奥井
裕俊 吉田
洋之 佐藤
市川 賢治
丈人 加藤
拓 山中
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Daikin Industries Ltd
Original Assignee
Daikin Industries Ltd
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Daikin Industries Ltd filed Critical Daikin Industries Ltd
Priority to EP20791021.7A priority Critical patent/EP3957656A4/en
Priority to JP2021514226A priority patent/JPWO2020213691A1/ja
Priority to US17/602,448 priority patent/US12503560B2/en
Priority to CN202080027617.6A priority patent/CN113661184A/zh
Publication of WO2020213691A1 publication Critical patent/WO2020213691A1/ja
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical
Priority to JP2023062221A priority patent/JP2023085494A/ja
Ceased legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08FMACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS OBTAINED BY REACTIONS ONLY INVOLVING CARBON-TO-CARBON UNSATURATED BONDS
    • C08F2/00Processes of polymerisation
    • C08F2/12Polymerisation in non-solvents
    • C08F2/16Aqueous medium
    • C08F2/22Emulsion polymerisation
    • C08F2/24Emulsion polymerisation with the aid of emulsifying agents
    • C08F2/26Emulsion polymerisation with the aid of emulsifying agents anionic
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08JWORKING-UP; GENERAL PROCESSES OF COMPOUNDING; AFTER-TREATMENT NOT COVERED BY SUBCLASSES C08B, C08C, C08F, C08G or C08H
    • C08J3/00Processes of treating or compounding macromolecular substances
    • C08J3/12Powdering or granulating
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08FMACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS OBTAINED BY REACTIONS ONLY INVOLVING CARBON-TO-CARBON UNSATURATED BONDS
    • C08F14/00Homopolymers and copolymers of compounds having one or more unsaturated aliphatic radicals, each having only one carbon-to-carbon double bond, and at least one being terminated by a halogen
    • C08F14/18Monomers containing fluorine
    • C08F14/26Tetrafluoroethene
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08FMACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS OBTAINED BY REACTIONS ONLY INVOLVING CARBON-TO-CARBON UNSATURATED BONDS
    • C08F2/00Processes of polymerisation
    • C08F2/04Polymerisation in solution
    • C08F2/10Aqueous solvent
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08FMACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS OBTAINED BY REACTIONS ONLY INVOLVING CARBON-TO-CARBON UNSATURATED BONDS
    • C08F6/00Post-polymerisation treatments
    • C08F6/001Removal of residual monomers by physical means
    • C08F6/003Removal of residual monomers by physical means from polymer solutions, suspensions, dispersions or emulsions without recovery of the polymer therefrom
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08FMACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS OBTAINED BY REACTIONS ONLY INVOLVING CARBON-TO-CARBON UNSATURATED BONDS
    • C08F6/00Post-polymerisation treatments
    • C08F6/14Treatment of polymer emulsions
    • C08F6/16Purification
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08FMACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS OBTAINED BY REACTIONS ONLY INVOLVING CARBON-TO-CARBON UNSATURATED BONDS
    • C08F6/00Post-polymerisation treatments
    • C08F6/14Treatment of polymer emulsions
    • C08F6/20Concentration
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08FMACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS OBTAINED BY REACTIONS ONLY INVOLVING CARBON-TO-CARBON UNSATURATED BONDS
    • C08F6/00Post-polymerisation treatments
    • C08F6/14Treatment of polymer emulsions
    • C08F6/22Coagulation
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08JWORKING-UP; GENERAL PROCESSES OF COMPOUNDING; AFTER-TREATMENT NOT COVERED BY SUBCLASSES C08B, C08C, C08F, C08G or C08H
    • C08J3/00Processes of treating or compounding macromolecular substances
    • C08J3/12Powdering or granulating
    • C08J3/16Powdering or granulating by coagulating dispersions
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08JWORKING-UP; GENERAL PROCESSES OF COMPOUNDING; AFTER-TREATMENT NOT COVERED BY SUBCLASSES C08B, C08C, C08F, C08G or C08H
    • C08J2327/00Characterised by the use of homopolymers or copolymers of compounds having one or more unsaturated aliphatic radicals, each having only one carbon-to-carbon double bond, and at least one being terminated by a halogen; Derivatives of such polymers
    • C08J2327/02Characterised by the use of homopolymers or copolymers of compounds having one or more unsaturated aliphatic radicals, each having only one carbon-to-carbon double bond, and at least one being terminated by a halogen; Derivatives of such polymers not modified by chemical after-treatment
    • C08J2327/12Characterised by the use of homopolymers or copolymers of compounds having one or more unsaturated aliphatic radicals, each having only one carbon-to-carbon double bond, and at least one being terminated by a halogen; Derivatives of such polymers not modified by chemical after-treatment containing fluorine atoms
    • C08J2327/18Homopolymers or copolymers of tetrafluoroethylene
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08JWORKING-UP; GENERAL PROCESSES OF COMPOUNDING; AFTER-TREATMENT NOT COVERED BY SUBCLASSES C08B, C08C, C08F, C08G or C08H
    • C08J2427/00Characterised by the use of homopolymers or copolymers of compounds having one or more unsaturated aliphatic radicals, each having only one carbon-to-carbon double bond, and at least one being terminated by a halogen; Derivatives of such polymers
    • C08J2427/02Characterised by the use of homopolymers or copolymers of compounds having one or more unsaturated aliphatic radicals, each having only one carbon-to-carbon double bond, and at least one being terminated by a halogen; Derivatives of such polymers not modified by chemical after-treatment
    • C08J2427/12Characterised by the use of homopolymers or copolymers of compounds having one or more unsaturated aliphatic radicals, each having only one carbon-to-carbon double bond, and at least one being terminated by a halogen; Derivatives of such polymers not modified by chemical after-treatment containing fluorine atoms
    • C08J2427/18Homopolymers or copolymers of tetrafluoroethylene

Definitions

  • the present disclosure relates to a method for producing a fluoropolymer powder.
  • a fluoropolymer-containing anionic surfactant When producing a fluoropolymer by emulsion polymerization, a fluoropolymer-containing anionic surfactant has been used. Recently, the use of hydrocarbon-based surfactants has been proposed in place of fluorine-containing anionic surfactants, and various studies have been conducted.
  • Patent Document 1 is characterized by including a step of removing or reducing a compound represented by the following general formula (1) or (2) from a polytetrafluoroethylene powder obtained by using a hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • a method for producing a modified polytetrafluoroethylene powder is described.
  • General formula (1) (H- (CF 2 ) m- COO) p M 1 (Wherein, m is 3 ⁇ 19, M 1 is H, a metal atom, NR 5 4 (R 5 may be the same or different organic groups H or C 1 -C 10), a substituent It is an imidazolium which may have a substituent, a pyridinium which may have a substituent, or a phosphonium which may have a substituent.
  • Patent Document 2 describes a method for reducing heat-induced discoloration of a fluorinated polymer resin, wherein the fluorinated polymer resin is a step of polymerizing a fluoromonomer in an aqueous dispersion medium to form an aqueous fluorinated polymer dispersion. It is produced by the step of isolating the fluorinated polymer from the aqueous medium by separating the wet form of the fluorinated polymer resin from the aqueous medium, and the step of drying to produce the fluorinated polymer resin in the dry form. , The method comprises a step of exposing the fluorinated polymer resin in a wet or dry form to an oxidizing agent.
  • the present disclosure provides a method for producing a fluoropolymer powder having a reduced content of a specific fluoropolymer compound by a simple method.
  • an acid is added to a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization using a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant, the pH is adjusted to 4.0 or less, and coagulation is performed using the following general formula ( Fluoro comprising a step (A1) of obtaining a wet fluoropolymer powder containing the fluoropolymer compound represented by 1A) and a step (B1) of heat-treating the wet fluoropolymer powder at a temperature of more than 150 ° C. and lower than 240 ° C.
  • a method for producing a polymer powder hereinafter, also referred to as “the first production method of the present disclosure”.
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder preferably contains two or more kinds of fluoropolymer compounds represented by the general formula (1A). Further, it is preferable that the wet fluoropolymer powder does not substantially contain the salt of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A).
  • the fluoropolymer is preferably polytetrafluoroethylene.
  • an acid is added to a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization using an aliphatic carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant, and the pH is adjusted to 4.0 or less for coagulation.
  • a step (A2) of obtaining a wet fluoropolymer powder containing a fluoropolymer compound represented by the following general formula (1A) and Provided is a method for producing a fluoropolymer powder (hereinafter, also referred to as “the second production method of the present disclosure”), which comprises a step (B2) of heat-treating the wet fluoropolymer powder at a temperature higher than 100 ° C.
  • the temperature of the heat treatment is preferably more than 150 ° C and less than 240 ° C.
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder preferably contains two or more kinds of fluoropolymer compounds represented by the general formula (1A).
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder does not substantially contain the salt of the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A).
  • the fluoropolymer is preferably polytetrafluoroethylene.
  • manufacturing method of the present disclosure it means a concept including both the first manufacturing method and the second manufacturing method of the present disclosure.
  • the production method of the present disclosure can produce a fluoropolymer powder in which the content of a specific fluoropolymer compound is reduced by a simple method.
  • organic group means a group containing one or more carbon atoms or a group formed by removing one hydrogen atom from an organic compound.
  • An example of the "organic group” is Alkyl groups, which may have one or more substituents, An alkenyl group which may have one or more substituents, An alkynyl group, which may have one or more substituents, A cycloalkyl group which may have one or more substituents, Cycloalkenyl groups, which may have one or more substituents, A cycloalkazienyl group which may have one or more substituents, Aryl groups, which may have one or more substituents, An aralkyl group which may have one or more substituents, A non-aromatic heterocyclic group, which may have one or more substituents, Heteroaryl groups, which may have one or more substituents, Cyano group, Holmil group, RaO-, RaCO-, RaSO 2- , Ra
  • an alkyl group which may have one or more substituents is preferable.
  • substituted means a substitutable group. Examples of the "substituent” include an aliphatic group, an aromatic group, a heterocyclic group, an acyl group, an acyloxy group, an acylamino group, an aliphatic oxy group, an aromatic oxy group, a heterocyclic oxy group, and an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group.
  • the aliphatic group may be saturated or unsaturated, and may be a hydroxy group, an aliphatic oxy group, a carbamoyl group, an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group, an aliphatic thio group, an amino group, or an aliphatic amino group. , Acylamino group, carbamoylamino group and the like.
  • the aliphatic group include an alkyl group having a total carbon atom number of 1 to 8, preferably 1 to 4, such as a methyl group, an ethyl group, a vinyl group, a cyclohexyl group, and a carbamoylmethyl group.
  • the aromatic group includes, for example, a nitro group, a halogen atom, an aliphatic oxy group, a carbamoyl group, an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group, an aliphatic thio group, an amino group, an aliphatic amino group, an acylamino group, a carbamoylamino group and the like. You may be doing it.
  • the aromatic group include aryl groups having 6 to 12 carbon atoms, preferably 6 to 10 total carbon atoms, for example, a phenyl group, a 4-nitrophenyl group, a 4-acetylaminophenyl group, and a 4-methanesulfonylphenyl group. And so on.
  • the heterocyclic group has a halogen atom, a hydroxy group, an aliphatic oxy group, a carbamoyl group, an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group, an aliphatic thio group, an amino group, an aliphatic amino group, an acylamino group, a carbamoylamino group and the like. You may.
  • Examples of the heterocyclic group include a 5- to 6-membered heterocycle having a total carbon number of 2 to 12, preferably 2 to 10, such as a 2-tetrahydrofuryl group and a 2-pyrimidyl group.
  • the acyl group includes an aliphatic carbonyl group, an arylcarbonyl group, a heterocyclic carbonyl group, a hydroxy group, a halogen atom, an aromatic group, an aliphatic oxy group, a carbamoyl group, an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group, an aliphatic thio group, and an amino group. , It may have an aliphatic amino group, an acylamino group, a carbamoylamino group and the like.
  • acyl group examples include an acyl group having a total carbon atom number of 2 to 8, preferably 2 to 4, such as an acetyl group, a propanoyl group, a benzoyl group, and a 3-pyridinecarbonyl group.
  • the acylamino group may have an aliphatic group, an aromatic group, a heterocyclic group and the like, and has, for example, an acetylamino group, a benzoylamino group, a 2-pyridinecarbonylamino group, a propanoylamino group and the like. You may be.
  • Examples of the acylamino group include an acylamino group having a total carbon number of 2 to 12, preferably 2 to 8, and an alkylcarbonylamino group having a total carbon number of 2 to 8, such as an acetylamino group, a benzoylamino group, and a 2-pyridinecarbonylamino group.
  • Groups, propanoylamino groups and the like can be mentioned.
  • the aliphatic oxycarbonyl group may be saturated or unsaturated, and may be a hydroxy group, an aliphatic oxy group, a carbamoyl group, an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group, an aliphatic thio group, an amino group, or an aliphatic group. It may have an amino group, an acylamino group, a carbamoylamino group and the like.
  • Examples of the aliphatic oxycarbonyl group include an alkoxycarbonyl group having a total carbon atom number of 2 to 8, preferably 2 to 4, such as a methoxycarbonyl group, an ethoxycarbonyl group, and a (t) -butoxycarbonyl group.
  • the carbamoyl group may have an aliphatic group, an aromatic group, a heterocyclic group and the like.
  • Examples of the carbamoyl group include an unsubstituted carbamoyl group, an alkylcarbamoyl group having a total carbon number of 2 to 9, preferably an unsubstituted carbamoyl group, and an alkylcarbamoyl group having a total carbon number of 2 to 5, for example, an N-methylcarbamoyl group. Examples thereof include N, N-dimethylcarbamoyl group and N-phenylcarbamoyl group.
  • the aliphatic sulfonyl group may be saturated or unsaturated, and may be a hydroxy group, an aromatic group, an aliphatic oxy group, a carbamoyl group, an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group, an aliphatic thio group, or an amino group. , It may have an aliphatic amino group, an acylamino group, a carbamoylamino group and the like.
  • Examples of the aliphatic sulfonyl group include an alkylsulfonyl group having a total carbon number of 1 to 6, preferably a total carbon number of 1 to 4, such as a methanesulfonyl group.
  • the aromatic sulfonyl group includes a hydroxy group, an aliphatic group, an aliphatic oxy group, a carbamoyl group, an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group, an aliphatic thio group, an amino group, an aliphatic amino group, an acylamino group, a carbamoylamino group and the like. You may be doing it.
  • Examples of the aromatic sulfonyl group include an arylsulfonyl group having a total carbon atom number of 6 to 10, such as a benzenesulfonyl group.
  • the amino group may have an aliphatic group, an aromatic group, a heterocyclic group and the like.
  • the acylamino group may have, for example, an acetylamino group, a benzoylamino group, a 2-pyridinecarbonylamino group, a propanoylamino group and the like.
  • the acylamino group includes an acylamino group having a total carbon number of 2 to 12, preferably a total carbon number of 2 to 8, and more preferably an alkylcarbonylamino group having a total carbon number of 2 to 8, such as an acetylamino group and a benzoylamino group. Examples include a group, a 2-pyridinecarbonylamino group, a propanoylamino group and the like.
  • the aliphatic sulfonamide group, aromatic sulfonamide group, heterocyclic sulfonamide group may be, for example, a methanesulfonamide group, a benzenesulfonamide group, a 2-pyridinesulfonamide group, or the like.
  • the sulfamoyl group may have an aliphatic group, an aromatic group, a heterocyclic group and the like.
  • the sulfamoyl group includes a sulfamoyl group, an alkylsulfamoyl group having a total carbon number of 1 to 9, a dialkylsulfamoyl group having a total carbon number of 2 to 10, and an arylsulfamoyl group having a total carbon number of 7 to 13.
  • Heterocyclic sulfamoyl group having 2 to 12 total carbon atoms more preferably sulfamoyl group, alkyl sulfamoyl group having 1 to 7 total carbon atoms, dialkyl sulfamoyl group having 3 to 6 total carbon atoms, total carbon
  • Examples include groups, 4-pyridinesulfamoyl groups and the like.
  • the aliphatic oxy group may be saturated or unsaturated, and may have a methoxy group, an ethoxy group, an i-propyloxy group, a cyclohexyloxy group, a methoxyethoxy group, or the like.
  • Examples of the aliphatic oxy group include an alkoxy group having a total carbon atom number of 1 to 8, preferably 1 to 6, such as a methoxy group, an ethoxy group, an i-propyloxy group, a cyclohexyloxy group, and a methoxyethoxy group.
  • the aromatic amino group and the heterocyclic amino group are an aliphatic group, an aliphatic oxy group, a halogen atom, a carbamoyl group, a heterocyclic group fused with the aryl group, an aliphatic oxycarbonyl group, preferably a total number of carbon atoms.
  • the aliphatic thio group may be saturated or unsaturated, and an alkylthio group having a total carbon number of 1 to 8, more preferably a total carbon number of 1 to 6, such as a methylthio group and an ethylthio group. , Carbamoylmethylthio group, t-butylthio group and the like.
  • the carbamoylamino group may have an aliphatic group, an aryl group, a heterocyclic group and the like.
  • Examples of the carbamoylamino group include a carbamoylamino group, an alkylcarbamoylamino group having a total carbon number of 2 to 9, a dialkylcarbamoylamino group having a total carbon number of 3 to 10, and an arylcarbamoylamino group having a total carbon number of 7 to 13.
  • Heterocyclic carbamoylamino group having 3 to 12 total carbon atoms preferably carbamoylamino group, alkylcarbamoylamino group having 2 to 7 total carbon atoms, dialkylcarbamoylamino group having 3 to 6 total carbon atoms, total number of carbon atoms 7-11 arylcarbamoylamino groups, heterocyclic carbamoylamino groups with 3-10 total carbon atoms, such as carbamoylamino groups, methylcarbamoylamino groups, N, N-dimethylcarbamoylamino groups, phenylcarbamoylamino groups, 4- Examples thereof include a pyridinecarbamoylamino group.
  • the manufacturing method of the present disclosure will be described in detail.
  • the fluoropolymer powder may contain specific fluoropolymer compounds represented by the following general formulas (1) and (2).
  • General formula (1) (H- (CF 2 ) m- COO) p M 1 (Wherein, m is 3 ⁇ 19, M 1 is H, a metal atom, NR 5 4 (R 5 may be the same or different organic groups H or C 1 -C 10), a substituent It is an imidazolium which may have a substituent, a pyridinium which may have a substituent, or a phosphonium which may have a substituent.
  • P is 1 or 2.
  • Formula (2) ( H- (CF 2 ) n -SO 3) q M 2 ( wherein, n is 4 ⁇ 20 .M 2 has H, a metal atom, NR 5 4, substituents It is an imidazolium which may have a substituent, a pyridinium which may have a substituent, or a phosphonium which may have a substituent.
  • Q is 1 or 2.
  • the production method of the present disclosure is a general formula contained in a wet fluoropolymer powder with respect to a wet fluoropolymer powder obtained from a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization using a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • an acid is added to a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization using a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant, and the pH is adjusted to 4.0 or less for coagulation.
  • the step (A1) of obtaining a wet fluoropolymer powder containing a fluoropolymer compound represented by the following general formula (1A) and the step of heat-treating the wet fluoropolymer powder at a temperature of more than 150 ° C. and lower than 240 ° C. (B1) are included. ..
  • the first production method of the present disclosure has the above-mentioned structure, and although it is a simple method, the specific fluoropolymer represented by the above general formulas (1) and (2) is reduced. A polymer powder can be obtained. Further, since the specific fluoropolymers represented by the general formulas (1) and (2) can be reduced at a relatively low temperature, the fluoropolymer obtained together with the reduction of the fluoropolymers represented by the general formulas (1) and (2) can be obtained. It is possible to prevent the polymer powder from fusing.
  • step (A1) an acid is added to the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization using a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant, the pH is adjusted to 4.0 or less, and the mixture is coagulated as described below.
  • This is a step of obtaining a wet fluoropolymer powder containing a fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A).
  • a wet fluoropolymer powder containing the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A) can be obtained by a method of adding an acid to the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion and adjusting the pH to 4.0 or less for coagulation. it can.
  • the pH of the aqueous dispersion By adjusting the pH of the aqueous dispersion to 4.0 or less, more preferably 3.5 or less, still more preferably 3.0 or less, even more preferably 2.5 or less, and particularly preferably 2.0 or less.
  • the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1) contained in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer can be changed to the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A).
  • a wet fluoropolymer powder containing the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) is obtained, and the heat treatment performed in the step (B1) contains the fluorine-containing compounds represented by the general formulas (1) and (2). The amount can be reduced.
  • the acid may be an organic acid or an inorganic acid, but is preferably an inorganic acid from the viewpoint of being less likely to remain during heat treatment, and is particularly selected from the group consisting of nitric acid, sulfuric acid, fuming sulfuric acid, perchloric acid, and hydrochloric acid.
  • nitric acid sulfuric acid
  • fuming sulfuric acid perchloric acid
  • hydrochloric acid hydrochloric acid
  • One is preferable, and at least one selected from the group consisting of nitric acid, sulfuric acid, and hydrochloric acid is more preferable.
  • As the organic acid succinic acid, oxalic acid, citric acid, trifluoroacetic acid and the like may be used.
  • the amount of the acid added is not limited, and may be appropriately set depending on the pH of the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion.
  • Examples of the method of adding the acid to coagulate include a method of stirring the aqueous dispersion while adding the acid. More specifically, the fluoropolymer can be coagulated by stirring in a container equipped with a stirrer to obtain a wet fluoropolymer powder containing the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A). The coagulation may also be carried out continuously using an in-line mixer or the like.
  • the temperature of the coagulation is not limited, but it can be carried out at, for example, 3 to 80 ° C. From the viewpoint of dispersion stability, 5 ° C. or higher is preferable, and 10 ° C. or higher is more preferable. Further, from the viewpoint of suppressing the granulation of secondary particles, 60 ° C. or lower is preferable.
  • the step (B1) is a step of heat-treating a wet fluoropolymer powder containing a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) at a temperature higher than 150 ° C and lower than 240 ° C.
  • a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) By changing the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) to the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) and then heat-treating, the fluoropolymer powder is suppressed while suppressing the fusion of the obtained fluoropolymer powder.
  • the amount of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1) contained therein can be efficiently reduced.
  • the heat treatment temperature is more than 150 ° C and less than 240 ° C. Since the specific fluorine-containing compound can be reduced more efficiently, the heat treatment temperature is preferably 155 ° C. or higher, more preferably 160 ° C. or higher, further preferably 165 ° C. or higher, further preferably 170 ° C. or higher, and 175 ° C. or higher. Is particularly preferable, and 180 ° C. or higher is particularly preferable. From the viewpoint of suppressing the fusion of the fluoropolymer powder, 235 ° C. or lower is more preferable, 230 ° C. or lower is further preferable, 225 ° C. or lower is even more preferable, 220 ° C. or lower is particularly preferable, and 215 ° C. or lower is particularly preferable. Most preferably, it is 210 ° C. or lower.
  • the heat treatment preferably dries the wet fluoropolymer powder.
  • drying means a heat treatment for reducing the water content of the wet fluoropolymer powder to 0.01% by mass or less.
  • the drying temperature is more than 150 ° C and less than 240 ° C. Since the specific fluorine-containing compound can be reduced more efficiently, the drying temperature is preferably 155 ° C. or higher, more preferably 160 ° C. or higher, further preferably 165 ° C. or higher, still more preferably 170 ° C. or higher, and 175 ° C. or higher. Is particularly preferable, and 180 ° C. or higher is particularly preferable.
  • 235 ° C. or lower is more preferable, 230 ° C. or lower is further preferable, 225 ° C. or lower is even more preferable, 220 ° C. or lower is particularly preferable, and 215 ° C. or lower is particularly preferable. Most preferably, it is 210 ° C. or lower.
  • fusion can be suppressed because the specific fluorine-containing compound can be efficiently reduced even when the heat treatment or drying temperature is relatively low.
  • fusion means that the average particle size changes significantly before and after drying, and in particular, the average particle size after drying becomes large.
  • the increase rate is preferably 5% or less, preferably 3% or less, and the productivity can be improved.
  • the method for measuring the average particle size may be appropriately selected depending on the type of fluoropolymer.
  • the average particle size is low molecular weight PTFE
  • a laser diffraction type particle size distribution measuring device manufactured by Nippon Laser Co., Ltd.
  • the cascade is not used, and the particle size distribution is measured at a pressure of 0.1 MPa and a measurement time of 3 seconds. It is a particle size corresponding to 50% of the measured particle size distribution integration.
  • the average particle size is a value measured in accordance with JIS K6891.
  • the heat treatment or drying time is preferably 120 minutes or more, more preferably 180 minutes or more, further preferably 240 minutes or more, and further preferably 300 minutes. The above is even more preferable.
  • the upper limit of the heat treatment or drying time is not particularly limited, but may be, for example, 1500 minutes or less, or 1200 minutes or less.
  • the temperature it is preferable to control the temperature to less than 240 ° C. or the temperature does not exceed 240 ° C., but the temperature may be 240 ° C. or higher as long as the effects of the present disclosure are not impaired. , 240 ° C. may be exceeded.
  • the time for the temperature to reach 240 ° C. or higher or the time for exceeding 240 ° C. is preferably 120 minutes or less from the viewpoint of suppressing the fusion of powders. It is more preferably 90 minutes or less, still more preferably 60 minutes or less, and even more preferably 30 minutes or less. Further, in the above heat treatment or drying, the time when the temperature becomes 240 ° C.
  • % Or less is preferable. More preferably, it is 30% or less, further preferably 20% or less, even more preferably 10% or less, particularly preferably 5% or less, and particularly preferably 3% or less. is there.
  • an acid is added to a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization using an aliphatic carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant to adjust the pH to 4.0 or less.
  • step (A2) an acid is added to a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization using an aliphatic carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant, and the pH is adjusted to 4.0 or less for coagulation.
  • This is a step of analyzing to obtain a wet fluoropolymer powder containing a fluoropolymer compound represented by the following general formula (1A).
  • the pH of the aqueous dispersion By adjusting the pH of the aqueous dispersion to 4.0 or less, more preferably 3.5 or less, still more preferably 3.0 or less, even more preferably 2.5 or less, and particularly preferably 2.0 or less.
  • the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1) contained in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer can be changed to the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A).
  • a wet fluoropolymer powder containing the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) is obtained, and the content of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formulas (1) and (2) is obtained by the heat treatment performed in the step (B2). Can be reduced.
  • the acid may be an organic acid or an inorganic acid, but an inorganic acid is preferable from the viewpoint of being less likely to remain during heat treatment, and in particular, at least selected from the group consisting of nitric acid, sulfuric acid, fuming sulfuric acid, perchloric acid, and hydrochloric acid.
  • an inorganic acid is preferable from the viewpoint of being less likely to remain during heat treatment, and in particular, at least selected from the group consisting of nitric acid, sulfuric acid, fuming sulfuric acid, perchloric acid, and hydrochloric acid.
  • One is preferable, and at least one selected from the group consisting of nitric acid, sulfuric acid, and hydrochloric acid is more preferable.
  • As the organic acid succinic acid, oxalic acid, citric acid, trifluoroacetic acid and the like may be used.
  • the amount of the acid added is not limited, and may be appropriately set depending on the pH of the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion
  • Examples of the method of adding the acid to coagulate include a method of stirring the aqueous dispersion while adding the acid.
  • the fluoropolymer can be coagulated by stirring in a container equipped with a stirrer to obtain a wet fluoropolymer powder containing a fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A).
  • the coagulation may also be carried out continuously using an in-line mixer or the like.
  • the temperature of the coagulation is not limited, but it can be carried out at, for example, 3 to 80 ° C. From the viewpoint of dispersion stability, 5 ° C. or higher is preferable, and 10 ° C. or higher is more preferable. Further, from the viewpoint of suppressing the granulation of secondary particles, 60 ° C. or lower is preferable.
  • the heat treatment temperature is over 100 ° C. Since the specific fluorine-containing compound can be reduced more efficiently, the heat treatment temperature is preferably 110 ° C. or higher, more preferably 120 ° C. or higher, further preferably 130 ° C. or higher, and particularly preferably 140 ° C. or higher. Further, since the above-mentioned specific fluorine-containing compound can be reduced more efficiently, more than 150 ° C. is preferable, 155 ° C. or higher is more preferable, 160 ° C. or higher is further preferable, 165 ° C. or higher is even more preferable, and 170 ° C. or higher is particularly preferable. 175 ° C. or higher is particularly preferable, and 180 ° C.
  • 240 ° C. or lower is preferable, less than 240 ° C. is more preferable, 235 ° C. or lower is more preferable, 230 ° C. or lower is further preferable, 225 ° C. or lower is even more preferable, and 220 ° C. or lower.
  • the following is particularly preferable, 215 ° C. or lower is particularly preferable, and 210 ° C. or lower is most preferable.
  • the heat treatment preferably dries the wet fluoropolymer powder.
  • drying means a heat treatment for reducing the water content of the wet fluoropolymer powder to 0.010% by mass or less.
  • the drying temperature is over 100 ° C. Since the specific fluorine-containing compound can be reduced more efficiently, the drying temperature is preferably 110 ° C. or higher, more preferably 120 ° C. or higher, further preferably 130 ° C. or higher, and particularly preferably 140 ° C. or higher. Further, since the specific fluorine-containing compound can be reduced more efficiently, the drying temperature is preferably more than 150 ° C., more preferably 155 ° C. or higher, further preferably 160 ° C.
  • 240 ° C. or lower is preferable, less than 240 ° C. is more preferable, 235 ° C. or lower is more preferable, 230 ° C. or lower is further preferable, 225 ° C. or lower is even more preferable, and 220 ° C. or lower.
  • the following is particularly preferable, 215 ° C. or lower is particularly preferable, and 210 ° C. or lower is most preferable.
  • the specific fluorine-containing compound can be efficiently reduced even when the heat treatment or drying temperature is relatively low, so that fusion can be suppressed.
  • fusion means that the average particle size changes significantly before and after drying, and in particular, the average particle size after drying becomes large.
  • Up rate (amount remaining on 10 mesh (g)) / (total amount of sieved fluoropolymer (g)) ⁇ 100
  • the increase rate is preferably 5% or less, preferably 3% or less, and the productivity can be improved.
  • the method for measuring the average particle size may be appropriately selected depending on the type of fluoropolymer.
  • the average particle size is low molecular weight PTFE
  • a laser diffraction type particle size distribution measuring device manufactured by Nippon Laser Co., Ltd.
  • the cascade is not used, and the particle size distribution is measured at a pressure of 0.1 MPa and a measurement time of 3 seconds. It is a particle size corresponding to 50% of the measured particle size distribution integration.
  • the average particle size is a value measured in accordance with JIS K6891.
  • the heat treatment or drying time is preferably 120 minutes or more, more preferably 180 minutes or more, further preferably 240 minutes or more, and 300. Minutes or more are even more preferable.
  • the upper limit of the heat treatment or drying time is not particularly limited, but may be, for example, 1500 minutes or less, or 1200 minutes or less.
  • the temperature it is preferable to control the temperature to less than 240 ° C. or the temperature does not exceed 240 ° C., but the temperature may be 240 ° C. or higher as long as the effects of the present disclosure are not impaired. , 240 ° C. may be exceeded.
  • the time for the temperature to reach 240 ° C. or higher or the time for exceeding 240 ° C. is preferably 120 minutes or less from the viewpoint of suppressing the fusion of powders. It is more preferably 90 minutes or less, still more preferably 60 minutes or less, and even more preferably 30 minutes or less. Further, in the above heat treatment or drying, the time when the temperature becomes 240 ° C.
  • % Or less is preferable. More preferably, it is 30% or less, further preferably 20% or less, even more preferably 10% or less, particularly preferably 5% or less, and particularly preferably 3% or less. is there.
  • drying of the wet powder obtained by coagulation of the fluoropolymer is usually carried out in a vacuum, high frequency, hot air while maintaining a state in which the wet powder does not flow so much, preferably in a stationary state.
  • This is done by means such as.
  • the fluoropolymer is PTFE
  • friction between the powders, especially at high temperatures generally has an unfavorable effect on the fine powder type PTFE. This is because particles made of this type of PTFE are easily fibrillated even by a small shearing force and have the property of losing their original stable particle structure.
  • the presence or absence of fibrillation can be determined by "paste extrusion", which is a typical method for molding "high molecular weight PTFE powder” which is a powder (fine powder) made from an emulsified polymer of TFE. ..
  • paste extrusion is possible because the high molecular weight PTFE powder has fibrillation properties. If the unbaked molded product obtained by paste extrusion does not have substantial strength or elongation, for example, if the elongation is 0% and it breaks when pulled, it can be considered that there is no fibrillation property.
  • the solid content concentration of the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is not limited, but may be, for example, 1.0 to 70.0% by mass.
  • the solid content concentration is preferably 8.0% by mass or more, more preferably 10.0% by mass or more, and more preferably 60.0% by mass or less, more preferably 50.0% by mass or less.
  • the solid content concentration is preferably 10.0 to 25.0% by mass, preferably 10.0 to 22.0% by mass, and 10.0 to 20.0% by mass. % Is more preferable.
  • the production method of the present disclosure may include a step of adding water to a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion to dilute it.
  • the solid content concentration can be diluted to 10.0 to 25.0% by mass.
  • the content of the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1) is not particularly limited.
  • it is preferable that the content of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) contained in the wet fluoropolymer powder obtained after coagulation is in the range described later.
  • the fluoropolymer solid content concentration in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is high.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer solid content in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion for coagulation is high, the degree of association of the primary particles of the fluoropolymer increases, and the primary particles of the fluoropolymer are densely associated and aggregated to form granules.
  • the fluoropolymer solid content concentration of the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is less than 8% by mass, the aggregation density of the primary particles of the fluoropolymer tends to be sparse, and it is difficult to obtain a fluoropolymer powder having a high bulk density.
  • the fluoropolymer solid content concentration in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is too high, the unaggregated fluoropolymer increases, and the unaggregated fluoropolymer solid content concentration in the agglomerated wastewater increases. If the concentration of unaggregated fluoropolymer solids in the coagulated wastewater is high, pipe blockage and wastewater treatment require cost and labor.
  • the unaggregated fluoropolymer solid content concentration in the coagulated wastewater is preferably low from the viewpoint of productivity of the fluoropolymer powder, more preferably less than 0.4% by mass, further preferably less than 0.3% by mass, and 0. .. Less than 2% by mass is particularly preferable.
  • the fluoropolymer solid content concentration of the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion exceeds 25% by mass, it is difficult to reduce the unaggregated fluoropolymer solid content concentration of the coagulated wastewater to less than 0.4% by mass.
  • the fluoropolymer solid content concentration in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained in the polymerization step described later is about 8 to 45% by mass. Therefore, when the fluoropolymer solid content concentration is high, a diluting solvent such as water is added. Then, it may be adjusted to 8 to 25% by mass. When the fluoropolymer solid content concentration in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion after emulsion polymerization is 8 to 25% by mass, the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion can be used as it is as the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion.
  • the content of the fluoropolymer-containing compound represented by the general formula (1) contained in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is not limited, but is, for example, about 1 ppb to 10000 ppm with respect to the fluoropolymer. It is preferably 100 ppb or more, more preferably 1 ppm or more, still more preferably 10 ppm or more, and particularly preferably 100 ppm or more.
  • the aqueous dispersion to be subjected to the heat treatment may contain one type of fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1), or may contain two or more types, but two or more types. The manufacturing method of the present disclosure is particularly effective when it is included.
  • aqueous dispersion to be subjected to the heat treatment includes, as the above-mentioned fluorine-containing compound, a fluorine-containing compound having m of 7 or less in the general formula (1) and a fluorine-containing compound having m of 8 or more in the general formula (1A). It may contain a fluorine-containing compound having m of 8 or less in the general formula (1A) and a fluorine-containing compound having m of 9 or more in the general formula (1A).
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion contains a fluorine-containing compound having m of 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, 13, 15, 17 and 19 among the fluorine-containing compounds included in the general formula (1). It may be an embodiment that does not contain a fluorine-containing compound in which m is 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 and 18, or m is 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 and 18. And 20 may be included, and m may be 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, 13, 15, 17 and 19 and may not contain a fluorine-containing compound, or m may be 3 to 19. It may be an embodiment including all of the fluorine-containing compounds.
  • the concentration of the fluoropolymer-containing compound represented by the general formula (1) in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is not particularly limited, and the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion of any concentration can be coagulated.
  • the total amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound represented by the above general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, and 0.1 ppm or more, based on the fluoropolymer. It may be 0.5 ppm or more, 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, 10 ppm or more, and 100 ppm or more.
  • the total amount may also be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, 0.5 ppm or more, 1 ppm or more, and 5 ppm or more with respect to the total amount of water. It may be 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion to be treated may contain 10,000 ppm or less of the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1), 5000 ppm or less, and 2000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer.
  • ppm and ppb mean the values obtained by mass conversion unless otherwise specified.
  • Each of the two amounts may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, 0.5 ppm or more, 1 ppm or more, or 5 ppm or more with respect to the total amount of water. It may be 10 ppm or more, and may be 100 ppm or more.
  • the at least one amount may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, 1000 ppm or less, 500 ppm or less, respectively, with respect to the total amount of water. It may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 3 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 3 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 4 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 4 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 5 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 5 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 6 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 6 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 7 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 7 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 8 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 8 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 9 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 9 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 10 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 10 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 11 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 11 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 12 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 12 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 13 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 13 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 14 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 14 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 15 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 15 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 16 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 16 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 17 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 17 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 18 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 18 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 19 in the general formula (1) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 19 in the general formula (1) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1) contained in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1), and in the general formula (1), M 1 is a metal atom. , NR 5 4 (R 5 may be the same or different, H or an organic group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms), imidazolium which may have a substituent, and may have a substituent. Pyridinium or phosphonium which may have a substituent is preferable.
  • M 1 is H, a metal atom, and NR 5 4 (R 5 is It may be the same or different, and has H or an organic group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms), imidazolium which may have a substituent, pyridinium which may have a substituent, or a substituent. It is possible to obtain a fluoropolymer powder containing no or almost no fluorine-containing compound which is a phosphonium which may be present.
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion after adding the above acid is a salt of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) (preferably, the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1), and the general formula (1A).
  • M 1 is a metal atom
  • NR 5 4 R 5 may be the same or different, H or an organic group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms
  • imidazolium which may have a substituent. It is preferable that it is substantially free of pyridinium, which may have a substituent, or a fluorine-containing compound, which is a phosphonium which may have a substituent.
  • the fact that the salt of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) is substantially not contained means that the content of the salt of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) is for all m. Each means that it is 500 ppb or less.
  • the salt of the fluorine-containing compound having m of 3 in the general formula (1A) may be 400 ppb
  • the salt of the fluorine-containing compound having m of 9 may be 400 ppb or less
  • the fluorine-containing compound having m of 3 to 19 may be contained.
  • the total amount of salts of the compounds may be 500 ppb or less.
  • the salt content of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) may be 400 ppb or less, 300 ppb or less, 200 ppb or less, 100 ppb or less, respectively, for all m. It may be 50 ppb or less, and may be 10 ppb or less.
  • By adjusting the pH to 4.0 or less by adding an acid it is possible to obtain a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion that does not substantially contain the salt of the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A) as described above. ..
  • the content of the salt of the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer can be measured by, for example, an ion chromatography method (ion chromatography).
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder in the steps (A1) and (A2) may be obtained by coagulating a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization, and is generally a powder of water and a fluoropolymer. It contains a fluoropolymer represented by the formula (1A).
  • the water content in the wet fluoropolymer powder is not limited, but is, for example, about 0.01 to 1000% by mass with respect to the wet fluoropolymer powder.
  • the water content in the wet fluoropolymer powder is a value calculated by the following formula.
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder in the steps (A1) and (A2) contains a fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A).
  • the content of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) is not limited. For example, it may be 1 ppb or more, 10 ppb or more, 100 ppb or more, 1 ppm or more, 10 ppm or more, or 100 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. Further, it may be 10000 ppm or less, and may be 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer.
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder in the above steps (B1) and (B2) may contain one kind of fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A), or may contain two or more kinds.
  • the manufacturing method of the present disclosure is particularly effective when two or more kinds are included. For example, an embodiment containing a fluorine-containing compound having m of 7 and a fluorine-containing compound having m of 13 in the general formula (1A) can be mentioned.
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder in the steps (B1) and (B2) has, as the above-mentioned fluorine-containing compound, a fluorine-containing compound having an m of 7 or less in the general formula (1A) and an m of 8 or more in the general formula (1A). It may contain a fluorine-containing compound, and includes a fluorine-containing compound having an m of 8 or less in the general formula (1A) and a fluorine-containing compound having an m of 9 or more in the general formula (1A). May be good.
  • the wet fluoropolymer powders in the steps (B1) and (B2) have m of 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, 13, 15, 17 and 19 among the fluorine-containing compounds included in the general formula (1A). It may be an embodiment containing a certain fluorine-containing compound and not containing a fluorine-containing compound having m of 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 and 18, or m being 4, 6, 8, 10, It may be an embodiment containing a fluorine-containing compound of 12, 14, 16, 18 and 20 and not containing a fluorine-containing compound having m of 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, 13, 15, 17 and 19. However, the embodiment may include all of the fluorine-containing compounds having m of 3 to 19.
  • the concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder subjected to the heat treatment is not particularly limited, and the wet fluoropolymer powder having an arbitrary concentration can be treated. it can.
  • the total amount of the compounds represented by the above general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be. The total amount may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, 10 ppm or more, or 100 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer.
  • the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A) may have a fluoropolymer content of 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be less than or equal to, 500 ppm or less, and 200 ppm or less.
  • ppm and ppb mean the values obtained by mass conversion unless otherwise specified.
  • Each of the two amounts may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, 0.5 ppm or more, 1 ppm or more, or 5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the at least one amount may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, 1000 ppm or less, 500 ppm or less, and 200 ppm, respectively, with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be: When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 3 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 3 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 4 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, and 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. Well, it may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 4 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 5 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 5 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 6 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 6 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 7 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 7 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 8 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 8 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 9 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 9 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 10 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 10 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 11 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 11 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 12 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 12 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 13 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 13 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 14 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 14 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 15 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 15 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 16 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 16 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 17 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 17 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 18 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 18 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 19 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder is above a certain level as described above, the removal method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 19 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer compound in the wet fluoropolymer powder is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder is a salt of a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) (preferably a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1), and in the general formula (1), M 1 is metal atom, NR 5 4 (R 5 may be the same or different organic groups H or C 1 -C 10), which may imidazolium substituted, have a substituent It is preferable that it is substantially free of pyridinium, or a fluorine-containing compound which is a phosphonium which may have a substituent.
  • a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) preferably a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1), and in the general formula (1), M 1 is metal atom, NR 5 4 (R 5 may be the same or different organic groups H or C 1 -C 10), which may imidazolium substituted, have a substituent It is preferable that it is substantially free of pyridinium, or a fluorine-containing
  • the wet fluoropolymer powder does not substantially contain the salt of the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A), but the content of the salt of the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A) is all m. It means that it is 500 ppb or less, respectively.
  • the salt of the fluorine-containing compound having m of 3 in the general formula (1A) may be 400 ppb
  • the salt of the fluorine-containing compound having m of 9 may be 400 ppb or less
  • the fluorine-containing compound having m of 3 to 19 may be contained.
  • the total amount of salts of the compounds may be 500 ppb or less.
  • the salt content of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) may be 500 ppb or less, 400 ppb or less, 300 ppb or less, and 200 ppb or less for all m, respectively. It may be 100 ppb or less, 50 ppb or less, 10 ppb or less, and less than 10 ppb.
  • the salt content of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the wet fluoropolymer powder can be measured by, for example, an ion chromatography method (ion chromatography).
  • the pigments and fillers are uniformly mixed with pigments or fluoros with fillers.
  • Polymer powders can also be obtained.
  • the first production method of the present disclosure may also include the step of recovering the coagulated wet fluoropolymer powder after step (A1) and before step (B1).
  • the second production method of the present disclosure may also include the step of recovering the coagulated wet fluoropolymer powder after step (A2) and before step (B2).
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion in step (A1) was obtained by polymerizing a fluoromonomer using a carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • the first production method of the present disclosure preferably includes a polymerization step of obtaining a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion by polymerizing a fluoromonomer in an aqueous medium in the presence of a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion of the step (A2) was obtained by polymerizing a fluoromonomer using an aliphatic carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • the second production method of the present disclosure includes a polymerization step of obtaining a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion by polymerizing a fluoromonomer in an aqueous medium in the presence of an aliphatic carboxylic acid hydrocarbon-based surfactant. It is also preferable.
  • a fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1) is subjected to a polymerization step described later using a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant or an aliphatic type carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant.
  • a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion containing the above and substantially free of the compound represented by the general formula (2) can be obtained.
  • the place simply described as “carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant” is referred to as "aliphatic type carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant" in the second production method of the present disclosure. It shall apply.
  • the fluoromonomer preferably has at least one double bond.
  • the fluoromonomer include tetrafluoroethylene [TFE], hexafluoropropylene [HFP], chlorotrifluoroethylene [CTFE], vinyl fluoride, vinylidene fluoride [VDF], trifluoroethylene, fluoroalkyl vinyl ether, and fluoroalkylethylene.
  • a fluoromonomer represented by General formula (120): CF 2 CF-OCH 2- Rf 121 (In the formula, Rf 121 is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms).
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 ORf 131
  • Rf 131 is a linear or branched perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 6 carbon atoms, a cyclic perfluoroalkyl group having 5 to 6 carbon atoms, and 2 to 6 carbon atoms containing 1 to 3 oxygen atoms. It is a linear or branched perfluorooxyalkyl group of.).
  • General formula (140): CF 2 CFO (CF 2 CF (Y 141 ) O) m (CF 2 ) n F (In the formula, Y 141 represents a fluorine atom or a trifluoromethyl group.
  • M is an integer of 1 to 4.
  • n is an integer of 1 to 4.
  • CF 2 CF-O- (CF 2 CFY 151- O) n- (CFY 152 ) m- A 151
  • Y 151 represents a fluorine atom, a chlorine atom, a -SO 2 F group or a perfluoroalkyl group.
  • the perfluoroalkyl group may contain etheric oxygen and a -SO 2 F group. , 0 to 3.
  • n Y 151 may be the same or different.
  • Y 152 represents a fluorine atom, a chlorine atom or a -SO 2 F group. M is.
  • Y 152 represents an integer of 1 to 5 may be different or may be the same .
  • a 151 represents the -SO 2 X 151, -COZ 151 or -POZ 152 Z 153.
  • X 151 represents F, Cl, Br, I, -OR 151 or -NR 152 R 153 ;
  • Z 151 , Z 152 and Z 153 represent the same or different, -NR 154 R 155 or -OR 156 .
  • R 151 , R 152 , R 153 , R 154 , R 155 and R 156 represent alkyl, aryl, or sulfonyl-containing groups that may contain H, ammonium, alkali metal, or fluorine atoms, which may be identical or different. It is preferable that it is at least one selected from the group consisting of fluoromonomers represented by.).
  • perfluoroorganic group means an organic group in which all hydrogen atoms bonded to carbon atoms are replaced with fluorine atoms.
  • the perfluoroorganic group may have ether oxygen.
  • Examples of the fluoromonomer represented by the general formula (110) include a fluoromonomer in which Rf 111 is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms.
  • the number of carbon atoms of the perfluoroalkyl group is preferably 1 to 5.
  • Examples of the perfluoroorganic group in the general formula (110) include a perfluoromethyl group, a perfluoroethyl group, a perfluoropropyl group, a perfluorobutyl group, a perfluoropentyl group, a perfluorohexyl group and the like.
  • Rf 111 is a perfluoro (alkoxyalkyl) group having 4 to 9 carbon atoms, and Rf 111 is the following formula:
  • Rf 111 is the following formula:
  • n an integer of 1 to 4.
  • CF 2 CF-ORf 161
  • Rf 161 represents a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms.
  • a fluoromonomer represented by is preferable.
  • Rf 161 is preferably a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms.
  • the fluoroalkyl vinyl ether is preferably at least one selected from the group consisting of fluoromonomers represented by the general formulas (160), (130) and (140).
  • the fluoromonomer represented by the general formula (160) at least one selected from the group consisting of perfluoro (methyl vinyl ether), perfluoro (ethyl vinyl ether), and perfluoro (propyl vinyl ether) is preferable. At least one selected from the group consisting of fluoro (methyl vinyl ether) and perfluoro (propyl vinyl ether) is more preferable.
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF (CF 3 ) O (CF 2 ) 3 F
  • CF 2 CFO (CF 2 CF (CF 3 ) O) 2 (CF 2 ) ) 3 F
  • CF 2 CFO (CF 2 CF (CF 3 ) O) 2 (CF 2 )
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF 2 SO 2 F
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF (CF 3 ) OCF 2 CF 2 SO 2 F
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF ( CF 2 CF 2 SO 2 F) OCF 2 CF 2 SO 2 F
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF (SO 2 F) 2
  • At least one selected from the group is preferable.
  • CH 2 CFCF 2 CF 2 CF 2 CF 3
  • CH 2 CFCF 3 is 2, 3 , 3 , 3-Tetrafluoropropylene is preferred.
  • fluoroalkylallyl ether examples include, for example.
  • General formula (240): CF 2 CF-CF 2- ORf 111 (In the formula, Rf 111 represents a perfluoroorganic group.) Fluoromonomer represented by.
  • Rf 111 of the general formula (240) is the same as Rf 111 of the general formula (110).
  • Rf 111 a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms or a perfluoroalkoxyalkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms is preferable.
  • the general formula (230) (In the formula, X 231 and X 232 are independently F, Cl, methoxy groups or fluorinated methoxy groups, and Y 231 is of formula Y 232 or formula Y 233 .
  • Z 231 and Z 232 are independently F or a fluorinated alkyl group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms.)
  • Fluorinated vinyl heterocyclic bodies are mentioned.
  • CX 181 2 CX 182- R f 181 CHR 181 X 183
  • X 181 and X 182 are independently hydrogen atoms, fluorine atoms or CH 3
  • R f 181 are fluoroalkylene groups, perfluoroalkylene groups, fluoro (poly) oxyalkylene groups or perfluoro (poly).
  • An oxyalkylene group, R 181 is a hydrogen atom or CH 3
  • X 183 is a fluoromonomer represented by an iodine atom or a bromine atom.
  • CX 191 2 CX 192- R f 191 X 193
  • X 191 and X 192 are independent hydrogen atoms, fluorine atoms or CH 3
  • R f 191 is a fluoroalkylene group, a perfluoroalkylene group, a fluoropolyoxyalkylene group or a perfluoropolyoxyalkylene group.
  • X 193 is a fluoromonomer represented by an iodine atom or a bromine atom.
  • CF 2 CFO (CF 2 CF (CF 3 ) O) m (CF 2 ) n- X 201
  • m is an integer of 0 to 5
  • n is an integer of 1 to 3
  • X 201 is a cyano group, a carboxyl group, an alkoxycarbonyl group, an iodine atom, a bromine atom, or -CH 2 I.
  • Fluoromonomono represented by and General formula (210): CH 2 CFCF 2 O (CF (CF 3 ) CF 2 O) m (CF (CF 3 )) n- X 211
  • m is an integer of 0 to 5
  • n is an integer of 1 to 3
  • X 211 is a cyano group, a carboxyl group, an alkoxycarbonyl group, an iodine atom, a bromine atom, or -CH 2 OH.
  • Z 221 is linear or branched.
  • P is 0 or 1.
  • M / n is 0.2 to 5.
  • the molecular weight is 500 to 10000 (par). It is a fluoropolyoxyalkylene group.
  • X 183 and X 193 are iodine atoms.
  • R f 181 and R f 191 are preferably perfluoroalkylene groups having 1 to 5 carbon atoms.
  • R181 is preferably a hydrogen atom.
  • X 201 is preferably a cyano group, an alkoxycarbonyl group, an iodine atom, a bromine atom, or -CH 2 I.
  • X 211 is preferably a cyano group, an alkoxycarbonyl group, an iodine atom, a bromine atom, or -CH 2 OH.
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF (CF 3 ) OCF 2 CF 2 CN
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF (CF 3 ) OCF 2 CF 2 COOH
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF (CF 3 ) OCF 2 CF 2 CH 2 I
  • CF 2 CFOCF 2 CF 2 CH 2 I
  • CH 2 CFCF 2 OCF (CF 3 ) CF 2 OCF (CF 3 ) CN
  • CH 2 CFCF 2 OCF (CF 3 ) CF 2 OCF (CF 3 ) COOH
  • CH 2 CFCF 2 OCF (CF 3 ) CF 2 OCF (CF 3 ) CH 2 OH
  • CH 2 CHCF 2 CF 2 I
  • CF 2 CFO (CF 2 ) 5
  • the above fluoromonomer and the fluorine-free monomer may be polymerized.
  • the fluorine-free monomer include hydrocarbon-based monomers having reactivity with the fluoromonomer.
  • hydrocarbon-based monomer include alkenes such as ethylene, propylene, butylene, and isobutylene; alkyl vinyl ethers such as ethyl vinyl ether, propyl vinyl ether, butyl vinyl ether, isobutyl vinyl ether, and cyclohexyl vinyl ether; vinyl acetate, vinyl propionate, n.
  • the fluorine-free monomer may also be a functional group-containing hydrocarbon-based monomer (excluding the monomer that provides a cross-linking site).
  • the functional group-containing hydrocarbon monomer include hydroxyalkyl vinyl ethers such as hydroxyethyl vinyl ether, hydroxypropyl vinyl ether, hydroxybutyl vinyl ether, hydroxyisobutyl vinyl ether and hydroxycyclohexyl vinyl ether; itaconic acid, succinic acid, succinic anhydride and fumar.
  • Fluoro-free monomer having a carboxyl group such as acid, fumaric anhydride, crotonic acid, maleic acid, maleic anhydride, perfluorobuteneic acid; fluorine-free monomer having a glycidyl group such as glycidyl vinyl ether and glycidyl allyl ether; aminoalkyl Fluorine-free monomers having an amino group such as vinyl ether and aminoalkylallyl ether; fluorine-free monomers having an amide group such as (meth) acrylamide and methylol acrylamide can be mentioned.
  • particles of a desired fluoropolymer can be obtained by polymerizing one or more of the fluoromonomers.
  • the polymerization temperature and polymerization pressure in the above polymerization step are appropriately determined by the type of monomer used, the molecular weight of the target fluoropolymer, and the reaction rate.
  • the polymerization temperature is preferably 10 to 150 ° C.
  • the polymerization temperature is more preferably 30 ° C. or higher, and even more preferably 50 ° C. or higher. Further, 120 ° C. or lower is more preferable, and 100 ° C. or lower is further preferable.
  • the polymerization pressure is preferably 0.05 to 10 MPaG.
  • the polymerization pressure is more preferably 0.3 MPaG or more, and further preferably 0.5 MPaG or more.
  • 5.0 MPaG or less is more preferable, and 3.0 MPaG or less is further preferable.
  • 1.0 MPaG or more is preferable, 1.2 MPaG or more is more preferable, 1.5 MPaG or more is even more preferable, 1.8 MPaG or more is particularly preferable, and 2.0 MPaG is more preferable. The above is particularly preferable.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant at the start of polymerization is preferably more than 50 ppm with respect to the aqueous medium.
  • the amount of the hydrocarbon-based surfactant at the start of polymerization is preferably 60 ppm or more, more preferably 70 ppm or more, further preferably 80 ppm or more, still more preferably 100 ppm or more, and particularly preferably 100 ppm or more. It is 150 ppm or more, particularly preferably 200 ppm or more, and most preferably 300 ppm or more.
  • the upper limit is not particularly limited, but for example, it is preferably 10000 ppm, and more preferably 5000 ppm.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 3,391,099 includes two separate stages of the polymerization process, first the formation of polymer nuclei as nucleation sites, and then the polymerization of established particles. Dispersive polymerization of tetrafluoroethylene in an aqueous medium consisting of growth stages is disclosed. The polymerization is usually started when both the monomer to be polymerized and the polymerization initiator are filled in the reactor. Further, in the present disclosure, an additive related to the formation of a nucleation site is referred to as a nucleation agent.
  • the above-mentioned polymerization step is a step of polymerizing a fluoromonomer such as tetrafluoroethylene in an aqueous medium in the presence of a carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant It is also preferable to include a step of continuously adding the above.
  • the continuous addition of the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant is, for example, by adding the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant not all at once but over time and without interruption or in divisions. is there.
  • the step of continuously adding the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant is the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon when the concentration of the fluoropolymer formed in the aqueous medium is less than 0.60% by mass. It is preferable that the hydrocarbon-based surfactant is added to the aqueous medium. It is more preferable to start adding the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant when the concentration is 0.50% by mass or less, and further preferably to start adding when the concentration is 0.36% by mass or less. It is even more preferable to start adding when the amount is 0.30% by mass or less, particularly preferably to start adding when the amount is 0.20% by mass or less, and to add when the amount is 0.10% by mass or less.
  • the above concentration is the concentration with respect to the total of the aqueous medium and the fluoropolymer.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant added is 0.01 to 10% by mass with respect to 100% by mass of the aqueous medium. It is preferable to have.
  • a more preferable lower limit is 0.05% by mass, a further preferable lower limit is 0.1% by mass, a more preferable upper limit is 5% by mass, and a further preferable upper limit is 1% by mass.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant is preferably large, and the amount of the aqueous medium is 100 mass. It is preferably 0.01 to 10% by mass with respect to%. A more preferable lower limit is 0.1% by mass, and a more preferable upper limit is 1% by mass.
  • the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant is usually an anionic surfactant having a hydrophilic portion of a carboxylate and a hydrophobic portion which is a long-chain hydrocarbon portion such as alkyl.
  • the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant may be an aliphatic-type carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant, or may be a carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant other than the aliphatic-type.
  • the "aliphatic carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant” is a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon containing no carbonyl group (excluding the carbonyl group in the carboxyl group and the ester group). It means a system surfactant.
  • the ester group means a group represented by -COO- or -OCO-.
  • Examples of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant include the following formula: R 10- COM (Wherein, R 10 is a is .M monovalent organic group containing 1 or more carbon atoms, H, a metal atom, NR 11 4, good imidazolium be substituted, substituted Examples thereof include pyridiniums which may have a group or phosphoniums which may have a substituent, and R 11 is an H or an organic group, which may be the same or different). As R 11 , an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, and an organic group of H or C 1-4 is more preferable. From the viewpoint of surface activity, the number of carbon atoms of R 10 is preferably 2 or more, and more preferably 3 or more.
  • the number of carbon atoms of R 10 is preferably 29 or less, more preferably 23 or less.
  • the metal atom of M include alkali metals (Group 1) and alkaline earth metals (Group 2), and Na, K or Li are preferable.
  • the M, H, a metal atom or NR 11 4 are preferable, H, an alkali metal (Group 1), alkaline earth metal (Group 2) or NR 11 4, more preferably, H, Na, K, Li or NH 4 Is even more preferred, Na, K or NH 4 is even more preferred, Na or NH 4 is particularly preferred, and NH 4 is most preferred.
  • Examples of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant include R 12- COMM (in the formula, R 12 is a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 or more carbon atoms which may have a substituent, alkenyl. It is a cyclic alkyl group having 3 or more carbon atoms, an alkenyl group, an alkylene group or an alkenylene group which may have a group, an alkylene group or an alkenylene group, or a substituent, and these may contain an ether bond. When is 3 or more, a monovalent or divalent heterocycle may be contained, or a ring may be formed.
  • M is the same as above), and an anionic surfactant represented by the above can also be mentioned. Specifically, those represented by CH 3- (CH 2 ) n- COOM (in the equation, n is an integer of 2 to 28; M is the same as above) can be mentioned.
  • the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant preferably does not contain a carbonyl group (excluding the carbonyl group in the carboxyl group). Moreover, it is preferable that the surfactant used in the polymerization is only a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant containing no carbonyl group.
  • Examples of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant containing no carbonyl group include the following formula ( ⁇ ): R-COO-M ( ⁇ ) (Wherein, R is an alkyl group, an alkenyl group, an alkylene group or alkenylene group, which may contain an ether bond .M is H, a metal atom, NR 11 4, which may have a substituent A good imidazolium, a pyridinium which may have a substituent, or a phosphonium which may have a substituent. R 11 is the same or different, H or an organic group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms. The compound represented by) is preferably exemplified.
  • R is preferably an alkyl group or an alkenyl group (these may contain an ether group).
  • the alkyl group or alkenyl group in R may be linear or branched.
  • the carbon number of R is not limited, but is, for example, 2 to 29.
  • the alkyl group or alkenyl group in R preferably does not contain a carbonyl group (excluding the carbonyl group in the ester group).
  • the carbon number of R is preferably 3 to 29, and more preferably 5 to 23.
  • the carbon number of R is preferably 5 to 35, more preferably 11 to 23.
  • the carbon number of R is preferably 2 to 29, more preferably 9 to 23.
  • the carbon number of R is preferably 2 to 29, more preferably 3 to 29, and even more preferably 9 to 23.
  • alkyl group and alkenyl group examples include a methyl group, an ethyl group, an isobutyl group, a t-butyl group, a vinyl group and the like.
  • carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant examples include butyric acid, valeric acid, caproic acid, enanthic acid, capric acid, pelargonic acid, capric acid, lauric acid, myristic acid, pentadecylic acid, palmitic acid, and palmitreic acid.
  • lauric acid at least one selected from the group consisting of lauric acid, capric acid, myristic acid, pentadecic acid, palmitic acid, and salts thereof is preferable, lauric acid and its salts are more preferable, and lauric acid salts are particularly preferable.
  • lauric acid and its salts are more preferable, and lauric acid salts are particularly preferable.
  • sodium laurate or ammonium laurate is most preferred.
  • the salt the metal atom of the formula M hydrogen of the carboxyl groups mentioned above, NR 11 4, which may imidazolium substituted, pyridinium which may have a substituent, or a substituent Examples thereof include those which are phosphoniums which may be possessed, but are not particularly limited.
  • Examples of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant include the following formula (a): (In the formula, R 1a is a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 or more carbon atoms or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 or more carbon atoms, and the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom has a hydroxy group or an ester bond. It may be substituted with a monovalent organic group containing it, may contain a carbonyl group when it has 2 or more carbon atoms, and may contain a monovalent or divalent heterocyclic ring when it has 3 or more carbon atoms. It may be formed. R 2a and R 3a are independently single-bonded or divalent linking groups.
  • R 1a , R 2a and R 3a have a total of 5 or more carbon atoms.
  • a a. -COOX a (X a is H, a metal atom, NR 4a 4 , an imidazolium which may have a substituent, a pyridinium which may have a substituent, or a substituent. It is a good phosphonium, R 4a is an H or an organic group and may be the same or different.)
  • R 1a , R 2a and R 3a any two of them are bonded to each other to form a ring.
  • R 1b is a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 or more carbon atoms which may have a substituent or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 or more carbon atoms which may have a substituent. If the number of carbon atoms is 3 or more, a monovalent or divalent heterocycle may be contained or a ring may be formed.
  • R 2b and R 4b are independently H or a substituent.
  • R 3b is an H or a substituent.
  • a is .n alkylene group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms which may have a substituent
  • a is .p and q is an integer of 1 or more, independently, an integer of 0 or more .
  • a b is - COOX b (X b is H, a metal atom, NR 5b 4 , an imidazolium which may have a substituent, a pyridinium which may have a substituent, or a phosphonium which may have a substituent.
  • R 5b is an H or an organic group and may be the same or different.)
  • any two of them are bonded to each other to form a ring.
  • L may be a single bond, -CO 2 -B- *, -OCO-B- *, -CONR 6b -B- *, -NR 6b CO-B- *, or -CO- (provided that it is. , -CO 2 -B-, -OCO-B-, -CONR 6b -B-, -NR 6b CO-B- (excluding the carbonyl group), where B has a single bond or a substituent. and an alkylene group having from carbon atoms 1 also 10, R 6b may have an H or a substituent, an alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
  • * is the a b in the formula At least one selected from the group consisting of the surfactant (b) represented by (referring to the binding side) is also mentioned.
  • the surfactant (a) will be described.
  • R 1a is a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 or more carbon atoms or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 or more carbon atoms.
  • the alkyl group may contain a monovalent or divalent heterocycle when the number of carbon atoms is 3 or more, or a ring may be wound.
  • a monovalent or divalent heterocycle when the number of carbon atoms is 3 or more, or a ring may be wound.
  • an unsaturated heterocycle is preferable, an oxygen-containing unsaturated heterocycle is more preferable, and examples thereof include a furan ring.
  • a monovalent heterocycle may be located at the end of the alkyl group.
  • the "carbon number" of the alkyl group includes the number of carbon atoms constituting the carbonyl group and the number of carbon atoms constituting the heterocycle.
  • the group represented by CH 3- C ( O)-has 2 carbon atoms.
  • the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a functional group, for example, a hydroxy group (-OH) or a monovalent organic group containing an ester bond may be substituted. It is preferably not substituted with any functional group.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom.
  • R 2a and R 3a are independently single-bonded or divalent linking groups. It is preferable that R 2a and R 3a are independently a single bond or a linear or branched alkylene group having 1 or more carbon atoms or a cyclic alkylene group having 3 or more carbon atoms.
  • the alkylene groups constituting R 2a and R 3a preferably do not contain a carbonyl group.
  • the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a functional group, for example, a hydroxy group (-OH) or a monovalent organic group containing an ester bond may be substituted. It is preferably not substituted with any functional group.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom.
  • R 1a , R 2a and R 3a have a total of 5 or more carbon atoms.
  • the total number of carbon atoms is preferably 7 or more, more preferably 9 or more, preferably 20 or less, more preferably 18 or less, and even more preferably 15 or less. Any two of R 1a , R 2a and R 3a may be bonded to each other to form a ring.
  • a a is -COOX a
  • X a is H, a metal atom, NR 4a 4 , may have a substituent, imidazolium may have a substituent, or may have a substituent. It is a good pyridinium or a phosphonium which may have a substituent
  • R4a is an H or an organic group, which may be the same or different).
  • R 4a H or an organic group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms is preferable, and H or an organic group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms is more preferable.
  • the metal atom include alkali metals (Group 1) and alkaline earth metals (Group 2), and Na, K or Li are preferable.
  • H alkali metal (Group 1), alkaline earth metal (Group 2) or NR 4a 4 is preferable, and H, Na, K, Li or NH 4 is more preferable because it is easily dissolved in water. Further since the easily soluble in water, Na, K or NH 4 are more preferred, particularly preferably Na or NH 4 is, since removal is easy, NH 4 being the most preferred.
  • X a is NH 4
  • the solubility of the above-mentioned surfactant in an aqueous medium is excellent, and the metal component is unlikely to remain in the fluoropolymer or the final product.
  • R 1a includes a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 8 carbon atoms that does not contain a carbonyl group, a cyclic alkyl group having 3 to 8 carbon atoms that does not contain a carbonyl group, and 1 to 10 carbonyl groups.
  • Alkyl groups containing rings are preferred.
  • R 1a the following formula: (In the formula, n 11a is an integer of 0 to 10, R 11a is a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 to 5 carbon atoms, and R 12a. Is an alkylene group having 0 to 3 carbon atoms. When n 11a is an integer of 2 to 10, R 12a may be the same or different from each other.) The group represented by is more preferable.
  • n 11a an integer of 0 to 5 is preferable, an integer of 0 to 3 is more preferable, and an integer of 1 to 3 is further preferable.
  • the alkyl group as R 11a preferably does not contain a carbonyl group.
  • the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a functional group, for example, a hydroxy group (-OH) or a monovalent organic group containing an ester bond. It may be, but it is preferable that it is not substituted with any functional group.
  • the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be a halogen.
  • it may be substituted with an atom, it is preferably a non-halogenated alkyl group containing no halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom.
  • R 12a is an alkylene group having 0 to 3 carbon atoms. The number of carbon atoms is preferably 1 to 3.
  • the alkylene group as R 12a may be linear or branched.
  • the alkylene group as R 12a preferably does not contain a carbonyl group.
  • the R 12a an ethylene group (-C 2 H 4 -) or propylene group (-C 3 H 6 -) is more preferred.
  • the alkylene group as R 12a may have a hydrogen atom bonded to a carbon atom substituted with a functional group, for example, a hydroxy group (-OH) or a monovalent organic group containing an ester bond. It may be, but it is preferable that it is not substituted with any functional group.
  • R 104a is an alkyl group.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less is halogen.
  • it may be substituted with an atom, it is preferably a non-halogenated alkylene group containing no halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom.
  • the R 2a and R 3a independently, preferably an alkylene group having 1 or more carbon containing no carbonyl group, more preferably an alkylene group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms which does not contain a carbonyl group, an ethylene group (-C 2 H 4 -) or propylene group (-C 3 H 6 -) is more preferred.
  • R 1b is a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 or more carbon atoms which may have a substituent or a cyclic alkyl having 3 or more carbon atoms which may have a substituent. It is a group. When the number of carbon atoms is 3 or more, the alkyl group may contain a monovalent or divalent heterocycle, or may be wound with a ring. As the heterocycle, an unsaturated heterocycle is preferable, an oxygen-containing unsaturated heterocycle is more preferable, and examples thereof include a furan ring.
  • a monovalent heterocycle may be located at the end of the alkyl group.
  • the "carbon number" of the alkyl group also includes the number of carbon atoms constituting the heterocycle.
  • alkyl group as R 1b may have include a halogen atom, a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms, or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms.
  • a hydroxy group is preferable, and a methyl group and an ethyl group are particularly preferable.
  • the alkyl group as R 1b preferably does not contain a carbonyl group.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom.
  • it is preferably a non-halogenated alkyl group that does not contain a halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom.
  • the alkyl group preferably does not have any substituents.
  • a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms which may have a substituent or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms which may have a substituent is preferable.
  • a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms containing no carbonyl group or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms containing no carbonyl group is more preferable, and the number of carbon atoms having no substituent is preferable.
  • a linear or branched alkyl group of 1 to 10 is more preferable, and a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms having no substituent is even more preferable, and a methyl group (-CH). 3 ) or an ethyl group (-C 2 H 5 ) is particularly preferable, and a methyl group (-CH 3 ) is most preferable.
  • R 2b and R 4b are independently H or substituents.
  • the plurality of R 2b and R 4b may be the same or different from each other.
  • a halogen atom a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms, a cyclic alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a hydroxy group are preferable, and methyl.
  • a group and an ethyl group are particularly preferable.
  • the alkyl groups as R 2b and R 4b preferably do not contain a carbonyl group.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom.
  • it is preferably a non-halogenated alkyl group that does not contain a halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom.
  • the alkyl group preferably does not have any substituents.
  • the alkyl groups as R 2b and R 4b include linear or branched alkyl groups having 1 to 10 carbon atoms which do not contain a carbonyl group, or cyclic alkyl groups having 3 to 10 carbon atoms which do not contain a carbonyl group. Is preferable, a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms containing no carbonyl group is more preferable, and a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms having no substituent is preferable. Is more preferable, and a methyl group (-CH 3 ) or an ethyl group (-C 2 H 5 ) is particularly preferable.
  • linear or branched alkyl groups having 1 to 10 carbon atoms which do not contain H or a carbonyl group are preferable, and 1 to 3 carbon atoms which do not have H or a substituent are preferable.
  • the linear or branched alkyl group of H, methyl group (-CH 3 ) or ethyl group (-C 2 H 5 ) is even more preferable, and H is particularly preferable.
  • R 3b is an alkylene group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms which may have a substituent. When a plurality of R 3b are present, they may be the same or different.
  • the alkylene group preferably does not contain a carbonyl group.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom.
  • it is preferably a non-halogenated alkyl group that does not contain a halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom.
  • the alkylene group preferably does not have any substituents.
  • alkylene group a linear or branched alkylene group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms which may have a substituent or a cyclic alkylene group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms which may have a substituent may be used.
  • a linear or branched alkylene group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms containing no carbonyl group or a cyclic alkylene group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms containing no carbonyl group is preferable, and the number of carbon atoms having no substituent is preferable.
  • R 1b , R 2b , R 3b and R 4b may be bonded to each other to form a ring.
  • n is an integer of 1 or more. As n, an integer of 1 to 40 is preferable, an integer of 1 to 30 is more preferable, and an integer of 5 to 25 is further preferable.
  • p and q are independently integers greater than or equal to 0.
  • p an integer of 0 to 10 is preferable, and 0 or 1 is more preferable.
  • q an integer of 0 to 10 is preferable, and an integer of 0 to 5 is more preferable.
  • n, p and q are integers having a total of 6 or more. It is more preferable that the sum of n, p and q is an integer of 8 or more. The sum of n, p and q is also preferably an integer of 60 or less, more preferably an integer of 50 or less, and even more preferably an integer of 40 or less.
  • a b is -COOX b
  • X b is H, a metal atom, NR 5b 4 , imidazolium which may have a substituent, pyridinium which may have a substituent, or It is a phosphonium which may have a substituent
  • R 5b is an H or an organic group, which may be the same or different.
  • R 5b H or an organic group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms is preferable, and H or an organic group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms is more preferable.
  • the metal atom include alkali metals (Group 1) and alkaline earth metals (Group 2), and Na, K or Li are preferable.
  • X b may be a metal atom or NR 5b 4 (R 5b is as described above).
  • R 5b is as described above.
  • H alkali metal (Group 1), alkaline earth metal (Group 2) or NR 5b 4 is preferable, and H, Na, K, Li or NH 4 is more preferable because it is easily dissolved in water.
  • Na, K or NH 4 are more preferred, particularly preferably Na or NH 4 is, since removal is easy, NH 4 being the most preferred.
  • X b is NH 4
  • the solubility of the above-mentioned surfactant in an aqueous medium is excellent, and the metal component is unlikely to remain in the fluoropolymer or the final product.
  • L is a single bond, -CO 2 -B- *, -OCO-B- *, -CONR 6b -B- *, -NR 6b CO-B- *, or -CO- ( However, the carbonyl group contained in -CO 2 -B-, -OCO-B-, -CONR 6b -B-, and -NR 6b CO-B- is excluded), and B has a single bond or a substituent. It is an alkylene group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms, and R 6b is an alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms which may have H or a substituent. The alkylene group more preferably has 1 to 5 carbon atoms. Further, it is more preferable that the R 6b is an H or a methyl group. * Refers to the side connected to Ab in the equation.
  • L is preferably a single bond.
  • the above-mentioned surfactant preferably has an integral value of the total peak intensity observed in the region of 2.0 to 5.0 ppm of chemical shift of 10% or more.
  • the integrated value of the total peak intensities observed in the region of chemical shift 2.0 to 5.0 ppm is within the above range in the 1 H-NMR spectrum.
  • the surfactant preferably has a ketone structure in the molecule.
  • the integral value is more preferably 15 or more, preferably 95 or less, more preferably 80 or less, and further preferably 70 or less.
  • the above integrated value is measured in a heavy water solvent at room temperature. Heavy water is 4.79 ppm.
  • a compound represented by the general formula (1-0) (hereinafter, also referred to as “surfactant (1-0)”) can be used.
  • X is the same or different at each appearance, and is a divalent linking group or a binding hand;
  • A may be the same or different at each occurrence, -COOM (M is H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, which may imidazolium substituted, pyridinium which may have a substituent group or a substituted phosphonium may have a group, R 7 is, H, or an organic group);
  • R 8 is H or organic group;
  • R 6 is an alkyl group having 1 or more carbon atoms which may contain at least one selected from the group consisting of a carbonyl group, an ester group, an amide group and a sulfonyl group, which
  • R 1 to R 5 represent H or a monovalent substituent, provided that at least one of R 1 and R 3 is a group represented by the general formula: —Y—R 6 , R 2 and At least one of R 5 represents a group represented by the general formula: -X-A or a group represented by the general formula: -Y-R 6 . Any two of R 1 to R 5 may be bonded to each other to form a ring.
  • alkyl group as R 1 may have include a halogen atom, a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms, or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms.
  • a hydroxy group is preferable, and a methyl group and an ethyl group are particularly preferable.
  • the alkyl group as R 1 preferably does not contain a carbonyl group.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom.
  • it is preferably a non-halogenated alkyl group that does not contain a halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom.
  • the alkyl group preferably does not have any substituents.
  • the R 1, is preferably a straight chain or branched cyclic alkyl group of an alkyl group or substituent to 3 carbon atoms which may have a 10 having 1 to 10 carbon atoms which may have a substituent ,
  • a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms containing no carbonyl group or a cyclic alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms containing no carbonyl group is more preferable, and the number of carbon atoms having no substituent is preferable.
  • a linear or branched alkyl group of 1 to 10 is more preferable, and a linear or branched alkyl group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms having no substituent is even more preferable, and a methyl group (-CH). 3 ) or an ethyl group (-C 2 H 5 ) is particularly preferable, and a methyl group (-CH 3 ) is most preferable.
  • the alkyl group preferably has 1 to 10 carbon atoms.
  • X represents the same or different divalent linking group or bond in each appearance.
  • R 6 does not contain any of a carbonyl group, an ester group, an amide group and a sulfonyl group
  • X is a divalent containing at least one selected from the group consisting of a carbonyl group, an ester group, an amide group and a sulfonyl group. It is preferable that it is a linking group of.
  • R 8 represents H or an organic group.
  • an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, an organic group of H or C 1-4 is more preferable, and H is further preferable.
  • -COOM M is H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, good imidazolium may have a substituent and may have a substituent good phosphonium have a pyridinium or a substituent, R 7 .4 one R 7 is H or an organic group represents a good.
  • an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, and an organic group of H or C 1-4 is more preferable.
  • the metal atom include alkali metals (Group 1) and alkaline earth metals (Group 2), and Na, K or Li are preferable.
  • the M, H, a metal atom or NR 7 4 are preferable, H, an alkali metal (Group 1), alkaline earth metal (Group 2) or NR 7 4, more preferably, H, Na, K, Li or NH 4 Is even more preferred, Na, K or NH 4 is even more preferred, Na or NH 4 is particularly preferred, and NH 4 is most preferred.
  • an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, an organic group of H or C 1-4 is more preferable, and H is further preferable.
  • R 6 has one or more carbon atoms which may contain at least one selected from the group consisting of a carbonyl group, an ester group, an amide group and a sulfonyl group, which is the same or different at each appearance, between carbon atoms.
  • the number of carbon atoms of the organic group of R 6 is preferably 2 or more, preferably 20 or less, more preferably 2 to 20, and even more preferably 2 to 10.
  • the alkyl group of R 6 contains at least one or two selected from the group consisting of a carbonyl group, an ester group, an amide group and a sulfonyl group between carbon-carbon atoms. However, these groups are not contained at both ends of the above alkyl groups.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be a halogen atom.
  • a non-halogenated alkyl group containing no halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom is preferable.
  • R 6 General formula: -R 10 -Group represented by -CO-R 11 , General formula: -R 10 -Group represented by COO-R 11 General formula: a group represented by -R 11, General formula: -R 10- NR 8 Group represented by CO-R 11 or General formula: -R 10- CONR 8- R 11 groups, (In the formula, R 8 represents H or an organic group.
  • R 10 is an alkylene group and R 11 is an alkyl group which may have a substituent).
  • R 6 the group represented by the general formula: ⁇ R 10 ⁇ CO—R 11 is more preferable.
  • an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, an organic group of H or C 1-4 is more preferable, and H is further preferable.
  • the carbon number of the alkylene group of R 10 is preferably 1 or more, more preferably 3 or more, more preferably 20 or less, further preferably 12 or less, further preferably 10 or less, and particularly preferably 8 or less.
  • the carbon number of the alkylene group of R 10 is preferably 1 to 20, more preferably 1 to 10, and even more preferably 3 to 10.
  • the alkyl group of R 11 may have 1 to 20 carbon atoms, preferably 1 to 15, more preferably 1 to 12, further preferably 1 to 10, further preferably 1 to 8, and 1 to 6. Particularly preferably, 1 to 3 is even more preferable, 1 or 2 is particularly preferable, and 1 is most preferable. Further, the alkyl group of R 11 is preferably composed of only primary carbon, secondary carbon and tertiary carbon, and particularly preferably composed of only primary carbon and secondary carbon. That is, as the R 11, a methyl group, an ethyl group, n- propyl group, an isopropyl group are preferable, especially a methyl group is most preferred.
  • a compound represented by the general formula (1-1), a compound represented by the general formula (1-2) or a compound represented by the general formula (1-3) is preferable, and the compound represented by the general formula (1-3) is preferable.
  • the compound represented by 1-1) or the compound represented by the general formula (1-2) is more preferable.
  • R 12 is an alkylene group of C 1-10 .
  • R 12 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be a halogen atom.
  • a non-halogenated alkylene group containing no halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom is preferable.
  • Examples of the group represented by -Y-R 6, the general formula General formula: -R 10 -Group represented by -CO-R 11 , General formula: -OCO-R 10 -Group represented by -CO-R 11 General formula: -COO-R 10 -Group represented by -CO-R 11 General formula: -OCO-R 10 -Group represented by -COO-R 11 General formula: -Group represented by COO-R 11 General formula: -NR 8 CO-R 10 -Group represented by -CO-R 11 or General formula: -CONR 8- R 10- NR 8 A group represented by CO-R 11 (in the formula, R 8 , R 10 and R 11 are as described above) is preferable.
  • R 4 and R 5 are independently preferably H or C 1-4 alkyl groups.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less. May be substituted with a halogen atom, but a non-halogenated alkyl group containing no halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom is preferable.
  • an alkyl group of C 1-20 which may have H or a substituent is preferable, and an alkyl group of C 1-20 which does not have H or a substituent is preferable. Is more preferable, and H is further preferable.
  • Alkyl group of the R 3 may be substituted by 75% or less halogen atom of the hydrogen atoms bonded to carbon atoms, may be 50% or less is optionally substituted by halogen atom, 25% or less halogen atom although it may be substituted with, a non-halogenated alkyl group containing no halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom is preferable.
  • an alkyl group of C 1-20 which may have H, OH or a substituent is preferable, and C 1- which does not have H, OH or a substituent is preferable.
  • the alkyl group of 20 is more preferred, and H or OH is even more preferred.
  • 75% or less of the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be substituted with a halogen atom, 50% or less may be substituted with a halogen atom, and 25% or less may be a halogen atom.
  • a non-halogenated alkyl group containing no halogen atom such as a fluorine atom or a chlorine atom is preferable.
  • at least one of R 2A and R 5A has the general formula: represents a group represented by -X a -A.
  • X A is the same or different at each appearance, a divalent hydrocarbon group, or a bond; A may be the same or different at each occurrence, -COOM (M is H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, which may imidazolium substituted, pyridinium which may have a substituent group or a substituted phosphonium may have a group, R 7 is, H, or an organic group); Any two of R 1A to R 5A may be bonded to each other to form a ring. ), Such as a surfactant (1-0A).
  • the monovalent hydrocarbon group which may contain an ester group between carbon atoms preferably has 1 to 50 carbon atoms, and 5 to 20 carbon atoms. Is more preferable.
  • the hydrocarbon groups in R 1A to R 5A do not contain a carbonyl group (excluding the carbonyl group in the carboxyl group and the ester group). Any two of R 1A to R 5A may be bonded to each other to form a ring.
  • An alkyl group is preferable as the monovalent hydrocarbon group which may contain an ester group between carbon atoms.
  • the divalent carbon number of the hydrocarbon group is 1 to 50, more preferably 5 to 20.
  • Hydrocarbon group for X A does not contain a carbonyl group. Examples of the divalent hydrocarbon group include an alkylene group and an alkanediyl group, and an alkylene group is preferable.
  • any one of R 2A and R 5A is preferably a group represented by the above general formula: -X A- A, and R 2A is the above general formula: -X A-. It is more preferable that the group is represented by A.
  • R 2A is a group represented by the general formula: ⁇ XAA— A
  • R 1A , R 3A , R 4A and R 5A are H. Is.
  • X A is an alkylene group having a bond or a C 1-5.
  • R 2A is the general formula: a group represented by -X A -A, R 1A and R 3A are represented by -Y A -R 6 a group, Y a is the same or different at each occurrence, -COO -, - OCO-, or a bond, R 6 is identical or different at each occurrence, with one or more alkyl groups having a carbon number It is an aspect. In this case, it is preferable that R 4A and R 5A are H.
  • Examples of the aliphatic carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant represented by the general formula (1-0A) include glutaric acid or a salt thereof, adipic acid or a salt thereof, pimelic acid or a salt thereof, suberic acid or Examples thereof include the salt, azelaic acid or a salt thereof, sebacic acid or a salt thereof and the like.
  • the aliphatic carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant represented by the general formula (1-0A) may be a double chain 2 hydrophilic group type synthetic surfactant, for example, a Gemini type surfactant. Examples thereof include Geminisurf (Chukyo Yushi Co., Ltd.), Gemusurf ⁇ 142 (12 lauryl groups), Gemsurf ⁇ 102 (10 carbon atoms), Gemsurf ⁇ 182 (14 carbon atoms) and the like.
  • a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant (in the second production method, an aliphatic type carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant) is radically treated or treated. It may include a step of performing an oxidation treatment.
  • the radical treatment may be any treatment for generating radicals in the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant.
  • deionized water and a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant are added to a reactor to react. The reactor is sealed, the inside of the system is replaced with nitrogen, the temperature of the reactor is raised and the pressure is raised, a polymerization initiator is charged, and after stirring for a certain period of time, the reactor is depressurized to atmospheric pressure and cooled.
  • the above-mentioned oxidation treatment is a treatment in which an oxidizing agent is added to a carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • the oxidizing agent include oxygen, ozone, hydrogen peroxide solution, manganese oxide (IV), potassium permanganate, potassium dichromate, nitric acid, sulfur dioxide and the like.
  • the radical treatment or the oxidation treatment may be carried out in a pH-adjusted aqueous solution.
  • the pH of the aqueous solution for radical treatment or oxidation treatment is preferably less than 7, and the pH of the aqueous solution can be adjusted by using, for example, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, hydrochloric acid or the like.
  • the polymerization step further comprises an aqueous medium containing a carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant (in the second production method, an aliphatic-type carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant).
  • a step of adjusting the pH of the above to be basic the pH is preferably 7.1 or higher, more preferably 7.5 or higher, further preferably 8.0 or higher, particularly preferably 8.5 or higher, and even more preferably 9.0 or higher.
  • the step of adjusting the pH may be performed before the step of radical-treating or oxidizing the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant, or may be performed afterwards. It is preferable to do it later.
  • the method for adjusting the pH is not particularly limited, and examples thereof include a method of adding a pH adjusting agent to the aqueous medium.
  • the pH adjuster include ammonia, NaOH, potassium hydroxide, sodium carbonate, potassium carbonate, ammonium carbonate, sodium hydrogencarbonate, potassium hydrogencarbonate, ammonium hydrogencarbonate, sodium phosphate, potassium phosphate, sodium citrate, and citrate. Potassium, ammonium citrate, sodium gluconate, potassium gluconate, ammonium gluconate and the like can be used.
  • the pH can be measured with a pH meter manufactured by orion.
  • At least one kind of carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant may be used for the above polymerization.
  • two or more of the above-mentioned carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactants may be used at the same time as the surfactant, or remain in a volatile one or a molded product made of a fluoropolymer. If it is acceptable, other surfactants other than the above-mentioned carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant may be used at the same time.
  • surfactants examples include nonionic surfactants and silicone-based surfactants.
  • Rf 241- (X 241 ) n- Y 241 (In the formula, Rf 241 is a partially fluorinated alkyl group or a fully fluorinated alkyl group having 1 to 12 carbon atoms, and n is 0.
  • X 241 is -O -, - COO- or a -OCO-
  • Y 241 is - (CH 2) p H, - (CH 2) p OH or - (oR 241) q (oR 242 ) R OH
  • p is an integer of 1 to 12
  • q is an integer of 1 to 12
  • r is an integer of 0 to 12
  • R 241 and R 242 have 2 to 4 carbon atoms. It is an alkylene group having.
  • R 241 and R 242 are different from each other.
  • Block polymer represented by, A nonionic polymer having a hydrophobic group consisting of a hydrocarbon group having 8 to 20 carbon atoms and a hydrophilic group consisting of a polyalkylene oxide in the molecule, and General formula (260): R 261 m -Si- (OR 262 ) 4-m (In the formula, R 261 is an alkyl group having 1 to 12 carbon atoms, R 262 is an alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, and m is an integer of 1 to 3). Silicon compound, At least one selected from the group consisting of is preferable.
  • block polymer represented by the general formula (250) include a block polymer consisting of at least two segments selected from the group of polyoxyethylene, polyoxypropylene, and polyoxybutylene. .. Among them, polyoxyethylene-polyoxypropylene block polymer and polyoxyethylene-polyoxybutylene block polymer are exemplified, and not only AB type but also ABA type block polymer is preferably exemplified. More preferably, by using a polyoxyethylene-polyoxypropylene block polymer or a polyoxypropylene-polyoxyethylene-polyoxypropylene block polymer, a highly concentrated and stable fluoropolymer dispersion can be prepared.
  • the content of the polyoxyethylene segment is 10 to 50%, the generation of agglomerates which is considered to be due to reaggregation is small, which is preferable. It is preferable because the liquid can be prepared.
  • the molecular weight is not particularly limited, but may be 1000 to 7000 g / mol, and a dispersion having a low viscosity and excellent dispersibility can be prepared particularly at 2500 to 6500 g / mol.
  • Silicone-based surfactants include Silicone Surfactants, R. et al. M. Hill, Marcel Dekker, Inc. , ISBN: 0-8247-00104.
  • the structure of silicone-based surfactants includes distinct hydrophobic and hydrophilic moieties.
  • the hydrophobic moiety comprises one or more dihydrocarbylsiloxane units, where the substituents on the silicone atom are completely hydrocarbons.
  • These siloxane surfactants can also be considered hydrocarbon-based surfactants in the sense that they are completely substituted by hydrogen atoms when the carbon atoms of the hydrocarbyl group can be substituted by halogens such as fluorine. That is, the monovalent substituent on the carbon atom of the hydrocarbyl group is hydrogen.
  • Hydrophilic moieties of silicone-based surfactants include phosphonates, phosphate esters, carboxylates, carbonates, taurates (as free acids, salts or esters), phosphine oxides, betaines, betaine copolyols, quaternary ammonium salts, etc. It may contain one or more polar moieties containing an ionic group.
  • the ionic hydrophobic moiety may also include an ionically functionalized siloxane graft.
  • silicone-based surfactants examples include polydimethylsiloxane-graft- (meth) acrylate, polydimethylsiloxane-graft-polyacrylate salt and polydimethylsiloxane grafted quaternary amine.
  • Polar moieties of the hydrophilic portion of silicone-based surfactants include polyethylene oxide (PEO), and mixed polyethylene oxide / propylene oxide polyether (PEO / PPO) and other polyethers; monosaccharides and disaccharides; It may contain a nonionic group formed by the water-soluble heterocyclic ring of.
  • the ratio of ethylene oxide to propylene oxide (EO / PO) can be varied in the mixed polyethylene oxide / propylene oxide polyether.
  • the hydrophilic moiety of the silicone-based surfactant may also include a combination of an ionic moiety and a nonionic moiety.
  • Such moieties include, for example, ionic terminal-functionalized or randomly functionalized polyethers or polyols.
  • a silicone-based surfactant having a nonionic moiety, that is, a nonionic silicone-based surfactant is preferable for carrying out the present disclosure.
  • silicone-based surfactants The arrangement of hydrophobic and hydrophilic moieties in the structure of silicone-based surfactants is diblock polymer (AB), triblock polymer (ABA) (where "B” represents the siloxane moiety of the molecule), or mulch. It may take the form of a block polymer. Alternatively, the silicone-based surfactant may contain a graft polymer.
  • Silicone-based surfactants are also disclosed in US Pat. No. 6,841,616.
  • Silicone-based anionic hydrocarbon-based surfactants include Lubrizol Advanced Materials, Inc. Examples thereof include SilSense TM PE-100 Silicone and SilSense TM CA-1 Silicone, which are available from Consumer Specialties of Noveon®.
  • anionic hydrocarbon-based surfactant examples include the sulfosuccinate surfactant Lankropol (registered trademark) K8300 of Akzo Nobel Interface Chemistry LLC.
  • examples of the sulfosuccinate hydrocarbon-based surfactant include diisodecyl sulfosuccinate salt (Clariant's Emulsogen® SB10), diisotridecyl sulfosuccinate Na salt (Cesapinia Chemicals Polar® TR / LNA) and the like. Be done.
  • Hydrocarbon-based surfactants include Omniova Solutions, Inc. PolyFox® surfactants (PolyFox TM PF-156A, PolyFox TM PF-136A, etc.) are also mentioned.
  • the total amount of the surfactants is preferably 50% by mass or more, more preferably 60% by mass or more, still more preferably 70% by mass or more, based on the amount. It is particularly preferably 80% by mass or more, and particularly preferably 90% by mass or more.
  • the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant and other surfactants are not substantially used in combination, and the content of the other surfactants is 1 mass by mass of the total amount of the surfactants. % Or less, more preferably 0.5% by mass or less, still more preferably 0.1% by mass or less.
  • carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant examples include the surfactant represented by the formula ( ⁇ ), the surfactant (1-0) represented by the general formula (1-0), and the above formula (a). Select from the group consisting of the represented surfactant (a), the surfactant (b) represented by the above formula (b), and the surfactant obtained by radically treating or oxidizing these surfactants. At least one type is preferable.
  • Examples of the aliphatic carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant include a surfactant represented by the formula ( ⁇ ), a surfactant represented by the general formula (1-0A), and these surfactants. At least one selected from the group consisting of surfactants subjected to radical treatment or oxidation treatment is preferable, and radicals are added to the surfactant represented by the formula ( ⁇ ) and the surfactant represented by the formula ( ⁇ ). At least one selected from the group consisting of treated or oxidized surfactants is particularly preferred.
  • the fluoromonomer is polymerized substantially in the absence of a fluorine-containing surfactant.
  • a fluoropolymer has been used for polymerization of a fluoropolymer, but the production method of the present disclosure reduces the content of the specific fluoropolymer even without using a fluoropolymer. Fluoropolymer powder can be obtained.
  • substantially in the absence of a fluorine-containing surfactant means that the amount of the fluorine-containing surfactant is 10 ppm or less, preferably 1 ppm or less, and more, with respect to the aqueous medium. It is preferably 100 ppb or less, more preferably 10 ppb or less, and even more preferably 1 ppb or less.
  • fluorine-containing surfactant examples include anionic fluorine-containing surfactants.
  • the anionic fluorine-containing surfactant may be, for example, a surfactant containing a fluorine atom having a total carbon number of 20 or less in a portion excluding the anionic group.
  • the fluorine-containing surfactant may also be a fluorine-containing surfactant having an anionic moiety having a molecular weight of 1000 or less, more preferably 800 or less, and even more preferably 600 or less.
  • the "anionic portion” means a portion of the fluorine-containing surfactant excluding the cation. For example, in the case of F (CF 2) n1 COOM of formula (I) to be described later, a part of the "F (CF 2) n1 COO".
  • Examples of the fluorine-containing surfactant include a fluorine-containing surfactant having a Log POW of 3.5 or less.
  • the LogPOW is the partition coefficient between 1-octanol and water.
  • P is the octanol when the octanol / water (1: 1) mixture containing the fluorine-containing interface active agent is phase-separated. Represents the concentration of fluorine-containing surfactant / concentration of fluorine-containing surfactant in water].
  • anionic fluorine-containing surfactant As the anionic fluorine-containing surfactant, the following general formula (N 0 ): X n0- Rf n0- Y 0 (N 0 ) (In the formula, X n0 is H, Cl or F. Rf n0 has 3 to 20 carbon atoms and is chain-like, branched-chain or cyclic, with some or all of H substituted by F. The alkylene group may contain one or more ether bonds, and a part of H may be substituted with Cl. Y 0 is an anionic group). Can be mentioned. Anionic group Y 0 is, -COOM, -SO 2 M, or may be a -SO 3 M, -COOM, or may be a -SO 3 M.
  • M is, H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, which may imidazolium substituted, a good phosphonium also have a pyridinium which may have a substituent or substituents, R 7 Is H or an organic group.
  • the metal atom include alkali metals (Group 1), alkaline earth metals (Group 2), and the like, and examples thereof include Na, K, and Li.
  • the R 7 may be an organic group of H or C 1-10 , an organic group of H or C 1-4 , or an alkyl group of H or C 1-4 .
  • M is, H, may be a metal atom or NR 7 4, H, an alkali metal (Group 1), alkaline earth metal (Group 2) or NR 7 may be 4, H, Na, K, Li or It may be NH 4 .
  • the Rf n0 may be such that 50% or more of H is replaced with fluorine.
  • N 0 As a compound represented by the above general formula (N 0 ), The following general formula (N 1 ): X n0- (CF 2 ) m1- Y 0 (N 1 ) (In the formula, X n0 is H, Cl and F, m1 is an integer of 3 to 15, and Y 0 is the one defined above.) The compound represented by the following general formula (N 2).
  • Rf n1 is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms
  • m2 is an integer of 0 to 3
  • X n1 is F or CF 3
  • Y 0 is defined above.
  • Rf n2 (CH 2 ) m3- (Rf n3 ) q- Y 0 (N 3 )
  • Rf n2 is a partially or fully fluorinated alkyl group which may contain an ether bond having 1 to 13 carbon atoms
  • m3 is an integer of 1 to 3
  • Rf n3 is linear.
  • it is a branched perfluoroalkylene group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms
  • q is 0 or 1
  • Y 0 is the one defined above.
  • N 4 The following general formula (N 4 ).
  • Rf n4 is a linear or branched chain moiety or a fully fluorinated alkyl group that may contain an ether bond having 1 to 12 carbon atoms
  • Y n1 and Y n2 are the same or different.
  • X n2 , X n3 and X n4 may be the same or different, and may contain an ether bond of H, F, or 1 to 6 carbon atoms, which is a linear or branched chain portion or complete. It is a fluorinated alkyl group.
  • Rf n5 is a linear or branched chain moiety or a fully fluorinated alkylene group that may contain an ether bond having 1 to 3 carbon atoms, and L is a linking group.
  • Y 0 is as defined above. However, the total carbon number of X n2 , X n3 , X n4 and Rf n5 is 18 or less).
  • Perfluorocarboxylic acid (II) perfluoropolyether carboxylic acid (III) represented by the following general formula (III), perfluoroalkylalkylene carboxylic acid (IV) represented by the following general formula (IV), the following general Perfluoroalkoxyfluorocarboxylic acid (V) represented by the formula (V), perfluoroalkylsulfonic acid (VI) represented by the following general formula (VI), ⁇ -H represented by the following general formula (VII).
  • the perfluorocarboxylic acid (I) has the following general formula (I).
  • F (CF 2 ) n1 COM (I) (Wherein, n1 is 3 is an integer of ⁇ 14, M is H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, which may imidazolium substituted, pyridinium which may have a substituent or It is a phosphonium which may have a substituent, and R 7 is represented by H or an organic group).
  • ⁇ -H perfluorocarboxylic acid (II) has the following general formula (II).
  • H (CF 2 ) n2 COMM (II) (In the formula, n2 is an integer of 4 to 15, and M is the one defined above.).
  • the perfluoropolyether carboxylic acid (III) has the following general formula (III).
  • Rf 1 is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms
  • n3 is an integer of 0 to 3
  • M is the one defined above.
  • the perfluoroalkylalkylenecarboxylic acid (IV) is represented by the following general formula (IV).
  • Rf 2 (CH 2 ) n4 Rf 3 COM (IV) (In the formula, Rf 2 is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms, Rf 3 is a linear or branched perfluoroalkylene group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms, and n4 is a perfluoroalkylene group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms. It is an integer, and M is as defined above.).
  • the alkoxyfluorocarboxylic acid (V) has the following general formula (V).
  • Rf 4- O-CY 1 Y 2 CF 2- COMM (V) (In the formula, Rf 4 is a linear or branched chain moiety or a fully fluorinated alkyl group that may contain an ether bond having 1 to 12 carbon atoms, and Y 1 and Y 2 are the same or different. , H or F, where M is as defined above).
  • the perfluoroalkyl sulfonic acid (VI) has the following general formula (VI). F (CF 2 ) n5 SO 3 M (VI) (In the formula, n5 is an integer of 3 to 14, and M is the one defined above.).
  • ⁇ -H perfluorosulfonic acid has the following general formula (VII).
  • H (CF 2 ) n6 SO 3 M (VII) (In the formula, n6 is an integer of 4 to 14, and M is the one defined above.).
  • the perfluoroalkylalkylene sulfonic acid (VIII) has the following general formula (VIII).
  • Rf 5 (CH 2 ) n7 SO 3 M (VIII) (In the formula, Rf 5 is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 13 carbon atoms, n7 is an integer of 1 to 3, and M is the one defined above.) ..
  • the alkylalkylene carboxylic acid (IX) has the following general formula (IX).
  • Rf 6 (CH 2 ) n8 COM (IX) (In the formula, Rf 6 is a linear or branched chain moiety or a fully fluorinated alkyl group that may contain an ether bond having 1 to 13 carbon atoms, and n8 is an integer of 1 to 3. M is as defined above).
  • the fluorocarboxylic acid (X) has the following general formula (X).
  • Rf 7- O-Rf 8- O-CF 2- COM (X) (In the formula, Rf 7 is a linear or branched chain moiety or a fully fluorinated alkyl group that may contain an ether bond having 1 to 6 carbon atoms, and Rf 8 is an alkyl group having 1 to 6 carbon atoms. It is a linear or branched chain moiety or a fully fluorinated alkyl group, where M is as defined above).
  • the alkoxyfluorosulfonic acid (XI) has the following general formula (XI).
  • Rf 9- O-CY 1 Y 2 CF 2- SO 3 M (XI) (In the formula, Rf 9 is a partially or fully fluorinated alkyl group which is a linear or branched chain which may contain an ether bond having 1 to 12 carbon atoms and may contain chlorine, and is Y. 1 and Y 2 are the same or different, H or F, and M is as defined above).
  • the compound (XII) has the following general formula (XII):
  • X 1 , X 2 and X 3 may be the same or different and may contain H, F and ether bonds of 1 to 6 carbon atoms in a linear or branched chain moiety or fully fluorinated. It is an alkyl group, Rf 10 is a perfluoroalkylene group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms, L is a linking group, and Y 0 is an anionic group. ).
  • Y 0 may be -COOM, -SO 2 M, or -SO 3 M, and may be -SO 3 M, or COM (in the formula, M is as defined above).
  • Examples of L include a single bond, a moiety capable of containing an ether bond having 1 to 10 carbon atoms, or a completely fluorinated alkylene group.
  • the compound (XIII) has the following general formula (XIII): Rf 11- O- (CF 2 CF (CF 3 ) O) n9 (CF 2 O) n10 CF 2 COM (XIII) (In the formula, Rf 11 is a fluoroalkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms containing chlorine, n9 is an integer of 0 to 3, n10 is an integer of 0 to 3, and M is the above definition. It is represented by). As the compound (XIII), CF 2 ClO (CF 2 CF (CF 3 ) O) n9 (CF 2 O) n10 CF 2 COONH 4 (mixture having an average molecular weight of 750, in the formula, n9 and n10 are defined above. There is.).
  • anionic fluorine-containing surfactant examples include a carboxylic acid-based surfactant and a sulfonic acid-based surfactant.
  • the polymerization step may further polymerize the fluoromonomer in the presence of a nucleating agent.
  • the nucleating agent is preferably at least one selected from the group consisting of, for example, fluoropolyether, nonionic surfactant, and chain transfer agent.
  • the polymerization step is preferably a step of obtaining a fluoropolymer by polymerizing a fluoromonomer in an aqueous medium in the presence of a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant and the nucleation agent.
  • fluoropolyether perfluoropolyether is preferable.
  • the fluoropolyether preferably has a repeating unit represented by the formulas (1a) to (1d).
  • (-CFCF 3- CF 2- O-) n (1a) (-CF 2- CF 2- CF 2- O-) n (1b) (-CF 2 -CF 2 -O-) n - (- CF 2 -O-) m
  • (1c) (-CF 2 -CFCF 3 -O-) n - (- CF 2 -O-) m (1d)
  • m and n are integers of 1 or more.
  • fluoropolyetheric acid or a salt thereof is preferable, and the fluoropolyetheric acid is preferably a carboxylic acid, a sulfonic acid, a sulfonamide, or a phosphonic acid, and more preferably a carboxylic acid.
  • a salt of fluoropolyetheric acid is preferable, an ammonium salt of fluoropolyetheric acid is more preferable, and an ammonium salt of fluoropolyethercarboxylic acid is further preferable.
  • the fluoropolyetheric acid or a salt thereof can have any chain structure in which oxygen atoms in the main chain of the molecule are separated by saturated fluorocarbon groups having 1 to 3 carbon atoms. Two or more types of fluorocarbon groups can be present in the molecule.
  • the fluoropolyetheric acid or a salt thereof has the following formula: CF 3 -CF 2 -CF 2 -O ( -CFCF 3 -CF 2 -O-) n CFCF 3 -COOH, CF 3 -CF 2 -CF 2 -O (-CF 2 -CF 2 -CF 2 -O- ) N- CF 2- CF 2 COOH, or HOOC-CF 2 -O (-CF 2 -CF 2 -O-) n - (- CF 2 -O-) m CF 2 COOH (In the formula, m and n are the same as above.) It is preferably a compound represented by or a salt thereof.
  • fluoropolyethers can have a carboxylic acid group or a salt thereof at one end or both ends.
  • fluoropolyethers may have a sulfonic acid or phosphonic acid group or a salt thereof at one end or both ends.
  • fluoropolyethers having acid functional groups at both ends may have different groups at each end.
  • the other end of the molecule is usually hyperfluorinated, but may contain hydrogen or chlorine atoms.
  • Fluoropolyethers having acid groups at one or both ends have at least two ether oxygens, preferably at least four ether oxygens, and even more preferably at least six ether oxygens.
  • at least one of the fluorocarbon groups that separate the ether oxygen more preferably at least two of such fluorocarbon groups, has two or three carbon atoms. Even more preferably, at least 50% of the fluorocarbon groups that separate ether oxygen have 2 or 3 carbon atoms.
  • the fluoropolyether has at least 15 carbon atoms in total, and for example, the preferable minimum value of n or n + m in the above repeating unit structure is at least 5.
  • fluoropolyethers having an acid group at one end or both ends can be used in the methods according to the present disclosure.
  • the fluoropolyether may contain multiple compounds in various proportions within the molecular weight range relative to the average molecular weight. ..
  • the fluoropolyether preferably has a number average molecular weight of 800 g / mol or more.
  • the number average molecular weight of fluoropolyetheric acid or a salt thereof is preferably less than 6000 g / mol because it may be difficult to disperse in an aqueous medium.
  • the number average molecular weight of the fluoropolyether acid or a salt thereof is more preferably 800 to 3500 g / mol, and further preferably 1000 to 2500 g / mol.
  • the amount of the fluoropolyether is preferably 5 to 3000 ppm, more preferably 5 to 2000 ppm, a further preferable lower limit of 10 ppm, and a further preferable upper limit of 100 ppm with respect to the aqueous medium.
  • nonionic surfactant examples include the above-mentioned nonionic surfactant, and a fluorine-free nonionic surfactant is preferable.
  • R 3- OA 1- H (i) (In the formula, R 3 is a linear or branched primary or secondary alkyl group having 8 to 18 carbon atoms, and A 1 is a polyoxyalkylene chain.) Can be mentioned.
  • the carbon number of R 3 is preferably 10 to 16, and more preferably 12 to 16. When the carbon number of R 3 is 18 or less, good dispersion stability of the aqueous dispersion can be easily obtained. Further, when the carbon number of R 3 exceeds 18, it is difficult to handle because the flow temperature is high. When the carbon number of R 3 is smaller than 8, the surface tension of the aqueous dispersion becomes high, and the permeability and wettability tend to decrease.
  • the polyoxyalkylene chain may be composed of oxyethylene and oxypropylene. It is a polyoxyalkylene chain consisting of an average number of repetitions of an oxyethylene group of 5 to 20 and an average number of repetitions of an oxypropylene group of 0 to 2, and is a hydrophilic group.
  • the number of oxyethylene units can include either the broad or narrow monomodal distribution usually provided, or the broader or bimodal distribution obtained by blending. When the average number of repetitions of the oxypropylene group is more than 0, the oxyethylene group and the oxypropylene group in the polyoxyalkylene chain may be arranged in a block shape or a random shape.
  • a polyoxyalkylene chain composed of an average number of repetitions of oxyethylene groups of 7 to 12 and an average number of repetitions of oxypropylene groups of 0 to 2 is preferable.
  • a 1 has an average of 0.5 to 1.5 oxypropylene groups because low foaming property is good.
  • R 3 is (R') (R'') HC-, where R'and R'' are the same or different linear, branched or cyclic alkyl groups. Yes, the total amount of carbon atoms is at least 5, preferably 7 to 17. Preferably, at least one of R'or R'' is a branched or cyclic hydrocarbon group.
  • nonionic surfactant examples include C 13 H 27- O- (C 2 H 4 O) 10- H, C 12 H 25- O- (C 2 H 4 O) 10- H, C. 10 H 21 CH (CH 3) CH 2 -O- (C 2 H 4 O) 9 -H, C 13 H 27 -O- (C 2 H 4 O) 9 - (CH (CH 3) CH 2 O) -H, C 16 H 33 -O- (C 2 H 4 O) 10- H, HC (C 5 H 11 ) (C 7 H 15 ) -O- (C 2 H 4 O) 9- H, etc. Be done.
  • Examples of commercially available products of the nonionic surfactant include Genapol X080 (product name, manufactured by Clariant), Neugen TDS-80 (trade name), and the Neugen TDS series (manufactured by Daiichi Kogyo Seiyaku Co., Ltd.).
  • Leocol TD-90 (trade name) as an example Leocol TD series (manufactured by Lion), Lionol (registered trademark) TD series (manufactured by Lion), T-Det A138 (trade name) as an example T-Det A
  • Examples thereof include a series (manufactured by Harcros Chemicals) and a Tagitol (registered trademark) 15S series (manufactured by Dow Chemicals).
  • the nonionic surfactant has an ethoxylate of 2,6,8-trimethyl-4-nonanol having an average of about 4 to about 18 ethylene oxide units, and an average of about 6 to about 12 ethylene oxide units 2, It is also preferable that it is an ethoxylate of 6,8-trimethyl-4-nonanol, or a mixture thereof.
  • This type of nonionic surfactant is also commercially available, for example, as TERGITOR TMN-6, TERGITOR TMN-10, and TERGITOR TMN-100X (all product names, manufactured by Dow Chemical Co., Ltd.).
  • the hydrophobic group of the nonionic surfactant may be any of an alkylphenol group, a linear alkyl group and a branched alkyl group.
  • a nonionic surfactant for example, the following general formula (ii) R 4- C 6 H 4- O-A 2- H (ii) (In the formula, R 4 is a linear or branched primary or secondary alkyl group having 4 to 12 carbon atoms, and A 2 is a polyoxyalkylene chain.)
  • examples thereof include ethylene alkylphenyl ether-based nonionic compounds.
  • Specific examples of the polyoxyethylene alkyl phenyl ether-based nonionic compound include Triton (registered trademark) X-100 (trade name, manufactured by Dow Chemical Co., Ltd.) and the like.
  • nonionic surfactant examples include a bifunctional group block copolymer supplied by BASF as a Pluronic® R series and a tridecyl alcohol alkoxylate supplied by BASF as an Iconol® TDA series. Be done.
  • the amount of the nonionic surfactant is preferably 0.1 to 0.000000001% by mass, more preferably 0.01 to 0.000001% by mass, based on the aqueous medium.
  • chain transfer agent examples include esters such as dimethyl malonate, diethyl malonate, methyl acetate, ethyl acetate, butyl acetate and dimethyl succinate, as well as isopentan, methane, ethane, propane, isobutane, methanol, ethanol and isopropanol. , Acetone, various mercaptans, various halogenated hydrocarbons such as carbon tetrachloride, cyclohexane and the like.
  • a bromine compound or an iodine compound may be used as the chain transfer agent.
  • Examples of the polymerization method using a bromine compound or an iodine compound include a method in which a fluoromonomer is polymerized in an aqueous medium in the presence of a bromine compound or an iodine compound in a substantially oxygen-free state (). Iodine transfer polymerization method).
  • Typical examples of the bromine compound or iodine compound used include, for example, the general formula: R a I x Br y (In the formula, x and y are integers of 0 to 2, respectively, and satisfy 1 ⁇ x + y ⁇ 2, and Ra is a saturated or unsaturated fluorohydrocarbon group having 1 to 16 carbon atoms or chlorofluoro. Examples thereof include a compound represented by a hydrocarbon group, or a hydrocarbon group having 1 to 3 carbon atoms, which may contain an oxygen atom).
  • a bromine compound or an iodine compound iodine or bromine is introduced into the polymer and functions as a cross-linking point.
  • Examples of the iodine compound include 1,3-diiodoperfluoropropane, 2-iodoperfluoropropane, 1,3-diiodo-2-chloroperfluoropropane, 1,4-diiodoperfluorobutane, and 1,5-.
  • At least one selected from the group consisting of alkanes and alcohols is preferable from the viewpoints of polymerization reactivity, cross-linking reactivity, availability, and the like.
  • the carbon number of the alkane is preferably 1 to 6, and more preferably 1 to 5.
  • the alcohol preferably has 1 to 5 carbon atoms, and more preferably 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
  • the chain transfer agent at least one selected from the group consisting of methane, ethane, propane, isobutane, methanol, ethanol, and isopropanol is particularly preferable.
  • the amount of the chain transfer agent is preferably 0.001 to 10000 ppm with respect to the aqueous medium.
  • the amount of the chain transfer agent is more preferably 0.01 ppm or more, further preferably 0.05 ppm or more, and particularly preferably 0.1 ppm or more with respect to the aqueous medium. Further, 1000 ppm or less is more preferable, 500 ppm or less is further preferable, and 100 ppm or less is particularly preferable with respect to the aqueous medium.
  • the chain transfer agent may be added collectively into the reaction vessel before the start of the polymerization, may be added collectively after the start of the polymerization, or may be added in a plurality of times during the polymerization. It may be added continuously during the polymerization.
  • an additive in addition to the above-mentioned hydrocarbon-based surfactant and other compounds having a surfactant ability to be used as desired, an additive can be used to stabilize each compound.
  • the additive include a buffer, a pH adjuster, a stabilizing aid, and a dispersion stabilizer.
  • paraffin wax paraffin wax, fluorine-based oil, fluorine-based solvent, silicone oil and the like are preferable.
  • the stabilizing aid may be used alone or in combination of two or more. Paraffin wax is more preferable as the stabilizing aid.
  • the paraffin wax may be liquid, semi-solid, or solid at room temperature, but saturated hydrocarbons having 12 or more carbon atoms are preferable.
  • the melting point of the paraffin wax is usually preferably 40 to 65 ° C, more preferably 50 to 65 ° C.
  • the amount of the stabilizing aid used is preferably 0.1 to 12% by mass, more preferably 0.1 to 8% by mass, based on the mass of the aqueous medium used. It is desirable that the stabilizing aid is sufficiently hydrophobic and completely separated from the fluoropolymer aqueous emulsion after emulsion polymerization of the fluoromonomer so that it does not become a contaminating component.
  • an aqueous medium, the above-mentioned hydrocarbon-based surfactant, a monomer and, if necessary, other additives are charged into the polymerization reactor, the contents of the reactor are stirred, and the reactor is determined. It can be carried out by maintaining the polymerization temperature of the above, and then adding a predetermined amount of the polymerization initiator to start the polymerization reaction. After the start of the polymerization reaction, a monomer, a polymerization initiator, a chain transfer agent, the above-mentioned surfactant and the like may be additionally added depending on the purpose. The above-mentioned hydrocarbon-based surfactant may be added after the polymerization reaction has started.
  • the polymerization initiator is not particularly limited as long as it can generate radicals in the above polymerization temperature range, and known oil-soluble and / or water-soluble polymerization initiators can be used. Further, the polymerization can be started as a redox in combination with a reducing agent or the like. The concentration of the polymerization initiator is appropriately determined depending on the type of monomer, the molecular weight of the target fluoropolymer, and the reaction rate.
  • an oil-soluble radical polymerization initiator or a water-soluble radical polymerization initiator can be used as the polymerization initiator.
  • the oil-soluble radical polymerization initiator may be a known oil-soluble peroxide, for example, dialkyl peroxy carbonates such as diisopropyl peroxy dicarbonate and disec-butyl peroxy dicarbonate, and t-butyl peroxy.
  • Peroxyesters such as isobutyrate and t-butylperoxypivalate, dialkyl peroxides such as dit-butyl peroxide, and di ( ⁇ -hydro-dodecafluorohexanoyl) peroxides and di ( ⁇ -Hydro-TetradecafluoroHeptanoyl) Peroxide, Di ( ⁇ -Hydro-Hexadecafluorononanoyl) Peroxide, Di (Perfluorobutyl) Peroxide, Di (Perfluorovaleryl) Peroxide, Di (Perfluorohexanoyl) peroxide, di (perfluoroheptanoyl) peroxide, di (perfluorooctanoyl) peroxide, di (perfluorononanoyl) peroxide, di ( ⁇ -chloro-hexafluorobutyryl) Peroxide, Di ( ⁇ -Chloro-Decaflu
  • a redox initiator that combines an oxidizing agent and a reducing agent as the polymerization initiator.
  • the oxidizing agent include persulfate, organic peroxide, potassium permanganate, manganese triacetate, ammonium cerium nitrate and the like.
  • the reducing agent include bromate, diimine, oxalic acid and the like.
  • the persulfate include ammonium persulfate and potassium persulfate.
  • a copper salt and an iron salt to the combination of the redox initiator.
  • the copper salt include copper (II) sulfate
  • examples of the iron salt include iron (II) sulfate.
  • the redox initiator include potassium permanganate / oxalic acid, potassium permanganate / ammonium oxalate, manganese triacetate / oxalic acid, manganese triacetate / ammonium oxalate, ammonium cerium nitrate / oxalic acid, ammonium cerium nitrate /.
  • ammonium oxalate examples thereof include ammonium oxalate, and potassium permanganate / oxalic acid is preferable.
  • a redox initiator either an oxidizing agent or a reducing agent may be charged in advance in the polymerization tank, and then the other may be continuously or intermittently added to initiate polymerization.
  • potassium permanganate / oxalic acid it is preferable to charge oxalic acid in the polymerization tank and continuously add potassium permanganate to the oxalic acid.
  • the amount of the polymerization initiator added is not particularly limited, but an amount (for example, several ppm to water concentration) or more that does not significantly reduce the polymerization rate is added collectively, sequentially, or continuously at the initial stage of polymerization. And add it.
  • the upper limit is a range in which the reaction temperature may be raised while removing heat from the apparatus surface with the heat of polymerization reaction, and a more preferable upper limit is a range in which the heat of polymerization reaction can be removed from the apparatus surface.
  • a radical polymerization initiator can also be used as the polymerization initiator.
  • Peroxide is preferable as the radical polymerization initiator.
  • the radical polymerization initiator include the above-mentioned oil-soluble radical polymerization initiator and water-soluble radical polymerization initiator, and the above-mentioned water-soluble radical polymerization initiator is preferable.
  • the water-soluble radical polymerization initiator is more preferably a peroxide, and even more preferably a persulfate, an organic peroxide, or a mixture thereof.
  • the persulfate include ammonium persulfate and potassium persulfate.
  • the organic peroxide include disuccinic acid peroxide and diglutaric acid peroxide.
  • ammonium persulfate and peroxide disuccinate are used.
  • 5 ppm or more of ammonium persulfate is preferably added to the aqueous medium, 10 ppm or more is more preferable, 20 ppm or more is further preferable, 30 ppm or more is further more preferable, and 40 ppm or more is particularly preferable.
  • 50 ppm or more is particularly preferable, 80 ppm or more is particularly preferable, and 100 ppm or more is particularly particularly preferable.
  • the radical polymerization initiator may be added continuously or intermittently after the polymerization is started.
  • the aqueous medium is a reaction medium for polymerizing and means a liquid containing water.
  • the aqueous medium is not particularly limited as long as it contains water, and water and a fluorine-free organic solvent such as alcohol, ether, and ketone, and / or a fluorine-containing organic solvent having a boiling point of 40 ° C. or lower are used. And may be included.
  • the average primary particle size of the fluoropolymer is, for example, 50 to 500 nm.
  • the lower limit of the average primary particle size is preferably 100 nm, more preferably 150 nm.
  • the upper limit of the average primary particle size is preferably 400 nm, more preferably 350 nm.
  • the average primary particle size can be measured by a dynamic light scattering method.
  • a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion was prepared with the average primary particle size adjusted to a fluoropolymer solid content concentration of about 1.0% by mass, and the refractive index of the solvent (water) was 25 ° C. using a dynamic light scattering method.
  • the dynamic light scattering method for example, ELSZ-1000S (manufactured by Otsuka Electronics Co., Ltd.) can be used.
  • the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant can also be suitably used as a dispersant for dispersing the fluoropolymer obtained by polymerization in an aqueous medium.
  • an aqueous dispersion containing the particles made of the above fluoropolymer, the above surfactant, and the above aqueous medium is usually obtained.
  • particles made of a fluoropolymer are dispersed in an aqueous medium in the presence of the surfactant.
  • the lower limit of the content of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant in the aqueous dispersion is preferably 10 ppb, more preferably 100 ppb, still more preferably 1 ppm, based on the fluoropolymer. It is even more preferably 10 ppm, and particularly preferably 50 ppm.
  • the upper limit is preferably 100,000 ppm, more preferably 50,000 ppm, still more preferably 10,000 ppm, and even more preferably 5,000 ppm with respect to the fluoropolymer.
  • the aqueous dispersion is obtained by combining the aqueous dispersion obtained by performing the above-mentioned polymerization, the dispersion obtained by concentrating or dispersing and stabilizing the aqueous dispersion, and the powder composed of a fluoropolymer. It may be any of those dispersed in an aqueous medium in the presence of an activator.
  • the aqueous dispersion obtained by the polymerization is subjected to (I) anion exchange resin or anion exchange resin and cation exchange in the presence of a nonionic surfactant.
  • anion exchange resin or anion exchange resin and cation exchange in the presence of a nonionic surfactant.
  • a dispersion can also be produced.
  • the nonionic surfactant is not particularly limited, but those described below can be used.
  • the anion exchange resin is not particularly limited, but known ones can be used. Further, as a method of contacting with the anion exchange resin, a known method can be used.
  • the aqueous dispersion obtained by the polymerization is subjected to step (I), and the aqueous dispersion obtained in step (I) is subjected to step (II) to purify the aqueous dispersion.
  • a liquid can be produced. It is also possible to produce a purified aqueous dispersion by performing step (II) without performing step (I). Further, the steps (I) and the steps (II) can be repeated or combined.
  • anion exchange resin for example, -N as a functional group + X - (CH 3) 3 group (. X is representing Cl or OH) strongly basic anion exchange resin having a, -N + X -
  • X is representing Cl or OH
  • Known examples include a strongly basic anion exchange resin having a (CH 3 ) 3 (C 2 H 4 OH) group (X is the same as above).
  • those described in International Publication No. 99/62858, International Publication No. 03/020836, International Publication No. 2004/078836, International Publication No. 2013/027850, International Publication No. 2014/084399, etc. Can be mentioned.
  • the above-mentioned "mixed bed composed of a cation exchange resin and an anion exchange resin” is not particularly limited, and when both are filled in the same column, when both are filled in different columns, both are filled. This includes the case where it is dispersed in an aqueous dispersion.
  • a known method is adopted as the method of concentration. Specific examples thereof include those described in International Publication No. 2007/046482 and International Publication No. 2014/084399. Examples thereof include phase separation, centrifugal sedimentation, cloud point concentration, electroconcentration, electrophoresis, filtration treatment using ultrafiltration, filtration treatment using a reverse osmosis membrane (RO membrane), nanofiltration treatment and the like.
  • the above concentration can concentrate the fluoropolymer concentration to 30 to 70% by mass depending on the application. Concentration may impair the stability of the dispersion, in which case a dispersion stabilizer may be added. As the dispersion stabilizer, the nonionic surfactant and various other surfactants may be added.
  • the nonionic surfactant is the same as the nonionic surfactant exemplified as the nucleating agent described above, and the nonionic surfactant described above can be appropriately adopted.
  • the nonionic surfactant preferably does not contain an aromatic moiety.
  • the cloud point of a nonionic surfactant is a measure of the solubility of the surfactant in water.
  • the surfactant used in the aqueous dispersions of the present disclosure has a cloud point of about 30 ° C. to about 90 ° C., preferably about 35 ° C. to about 85 ° C.
  • the total amount of the dispersion stabilizer is a concentration of 0.5 to 20% by mass with respect to the solid content of the dispersion. If it is less than 0.5% by mass, the dispersion stability may be inferior, and if it exceeds 20% by mass, there is no dispersion effect commensurate with the abundance and it is not practical.
  • the more preferable lower limit of the dispersion stabilizer is 2% by mass, and the more preferable upper limit is 12% by mass.
  • the method for producing a fluoropolymer powder of the present disclosure may include a step of recovering the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained in the above polymerization step.
  • the method for producing a fluoropolymer powder of the present disclosure may also include a step of recovering the coagulated wet fluoropolymer powder.
  • the monomer having the highest molar ratio of the monomer in the polymer (hereinafter, “the most monomer”) is a TFE polymer having TFE, the most monomer is a VDF polymer having VDF, and the most monomer.
  • the most monomer examples thereof include a CTFE polymer in which is CTFE.
  • the TFE polymer may preferably be a TFE homopolymer, or (1) TFE, (2) one or more fluorine-containing monomers other than TFE having 2 to 8 carbon atoms.
  • it may be a copolymer composed of VDF, HFP or CTFE, and (3) other monomers.
  • (3) other monomer include fluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) having an alkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms, particularly 1 to 3 carbon atoms; fluorodioxol; perfluoroalkylethylene; ⁇ -. Hydroperfluoroolefin; perfluoroallyl ether and the like can be mentioned.
  • the TFE polymer may also be a copolymer of TFE and one or more fluorine-free monomers.
  • fluorine-free monomer examples include alkenes such as ethylene and propylene; vinyl esters; and vinyl ethers.
  • the TFE polymer is also a copolymer of TFE, one or more fluorine-containing monomers having 2 to 8 carbon atoms, and one or more fluorine-free monomers. May be good.
  • the VDF polymer preferably includes (1) VDF, (2) one or more non-VDF fluoroolefins having 2 to 8 carbon atoms, particularly TFE, HFP or CTFE, and (3).
  • a copolymer composed of perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) having an alkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms, particularly 1 to 3 carbon atoms may be used.
  • the CTFE polymer may preferably be a CTFE homopolymer, or (1) CTFE, (2) one or more fluoroolefins other than CTFE having 2 to 8 carbon atoms.
  • CTFE may be a copolymer composed of TFE or HFP, and (3) perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) having an alkyl group having 1 to 5 carbon atoms, particularly 1 to 3 carbon atoms.
  • the CTFE polymer may also be a copolymer of CTFE and one or more fluorine-free monomers, and the fluorine-free monomers include alkenes such as ethylene and propylene; vinyl. Esters: Vinyl ethers and the like can be mentioned.
  • the fluoropolymer produced by the production method of the present disclosure can be glassy, plastic or elastomeric. These are amorphous or partially crystalline and can be subjected to compression firing, melting or non-melting.
  • a tetrafluoroethylene polymer [TFE polymer (PTFE)] as a non-melt processable fluororesin
  • an ethylene / TFE coweight as a melt processable fluororesin
  • Preferables include coalescing [ETFE], TFE / HFP copolymer [FEP], TFE / perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) copolymer [PFA, MFA, etc.], TFE / perfluoroallyl ether copolymer, electrolyte polymer precursor, etc. Can be manufactured in.
  • a fluororesin is preferable, a fluororesin having a fluororesin having a fluorine substitution rate of 50% or more calculated by the following formula is more preferable, and a fluororesin having a fluororesin having a fluorine substitution rate of more than 50% is more preferable.
  • a fluororesin having a substitution rate of 55% or more is even more preferable, a fluororesin having a fluorine substitution rate of 60% or more is even more preferable, a fluororesin having a fluorine substitution rate of 75% or more is even more preferable, and the fluororesin is still more preferable.
  • a fluororesin having a value of 80% or more is particularly preferable, and a fluororesin having a fluorine substitution rate of 90 to 100%, that is, a perfluororesin is most preferable.
  • Fluorine substitution rate (%) (number of fluorine atoms bonded to carbon atoms constituting the fluoropolymer) / ((number of hydrogen atoms bonded to carbon atoms constituting the fluoropolymer) + (carbon atoms constituting the fluoropolymer) Number of fluorine atoms and chlorine atoms bonded to)) ⁇ 100
  • a fluororesin having a fluorine substitution rate of 95 to 100% is more preferable, PTFE, FEP, and PFA are more preferable, PTFE is particularly preferable, and high molecular weight PTFE is particularly preferable.
  • the fluoropolymer may have a core-shell structure.
  • Fluoropolymers having a core-shell structure include, for example, modified PTFE containing a high molecular weight PTFE core in the particles and a lower molecular weight PTFE or modified PTFE shell. Examples of such modified PTFE include PTFE described in JP-A-2005-527652.
  • the core-shell structure may have the following structure.
  • Core TFE homopolymer Shell: TFE homopolymer Core: Modified PTFE Shell: TFE homopolymer Core: Modified PTFE Shell: Modified PTFE Core: TFE homopolymer Shell: Modified PTFE Core: Low molecular weight PTFE Shell: High molecular weight PTFE Core: High molecular weight PTFE Shell: Low molecular weight PTFE
  • the lower limit of the core ratio is preferably 0.5% by mass, more preferably 1.0% by mass, still more preferably 3.0% by mass, and particularly preferably 5.0% by mass. , Most preferably 10.0% by mass.
  • the upper limit of the core ratio is preferably 99.5% by mass, more preferably 99.0% by mass, still more preferably 98.0% by mass, still more preferably 97.0% by mass, and particularly preferably 95.0% by mass. %, Most preferably 90.0% by mass.
  • the lower limit of the shell ratio is preferably 0.5% by mass, more preferably 1.0% by mass, still more preferably 3.0% by mass, and particularly preferably 5.0% by mass. , Most preferably 10.0% by mass.
  • the upper limit of the ratio of the shell is preferably 99.5% by mass, more preferably 99.0% by mass, still more preferably 98.0% by mass, still more preferably 97.0% by mass, and particularly preferably 95.0% by mass. %, Most preferably 90.0% by mass.
  • the core or the shell may have two or more layers.
  • it may be a fluoropolymer having a three-layer structure having a core central portion of modified PTFE, a core outer layer portion of a TFE homopolymer, and a shell of modified PTFE.
  • the fluoropolymer having such a three-layer structure include PTFE described in International Publication No. 2006/054612.
  • the polymerization of TFE is usually carried out at a polymerization temperature of 10 to 150 ° C. and a polymerization pressure of 0.05 to 5 MPaG.
  • the polymerization temperature is more preferably 30 ° C. or higher, and even more preferably 50 ° C. or higher.
  • 120 ° C. or lower is more preferable, and 100 ° C. or lower is further preferable.
  • the polymerization pressure is more preferably 0.3 MPaG or more, further preferably 0.5 MPaG or more, still more preferably 5.0 MPaG or less, still more preferably 3.0 MPaG or less.
  • 1.0 MPaG or more is preferable, 1.2 MPaG or more is more preferable, 1.5 MPaG or more is further preferable, and 2.0 MPaG or more is more preferable.
  • pure water is charged in a pressure-resistant reaction vessel equipped with a stirrer, deoxidized, TFE is charged, the temperature is brought to a predetermined temperature, a polymerization initiator is added, and the reaction is started. If the pressure decreases as the reaction progresses, additional TFE is supplied continuously or intermittently to maintain the initial pressure. When a predetermined amount of TFE is supplied, the supply is stopped, the TFE in the reaction vessel is purged, the temperature is returned to room temperature, and the reaction is terminated. Additional TFE may be supplied continuously or intermittently so that the pressure does not drop.
  • modified PTFE In the production of the TFE polymer (PTFE), various known modified monomers can also be used in combination.
  • the above-mentioned PTFE includes not only a TFE homopolymer but also a copolymer of TFE and a modified monomer, which is non-meltable (hereinafter, referred to as "modified PTFE"). It is a concept.
  • the above-mentioned PTFE may be a homopolymer of TFE, or is a modified PTFE containing 99.0% by mass or more of a polymerization unit based on TFE and 1.0% by mass or less of a polymerization unit based on a modified monomer. May be good.
  • the content of the polymerization unit based on the modified monomer (hereinafter, also referred to as “modified monomer unit”) of the modified PTFE is in the range of 0.00001 to 1.0% by mass with respect to the total polymerization units of the modified PTFE. Is preferable.
  • As the lower limit of the modified monomer unit 0.0001% by mass is more preferable, 0.001% by mass is further preferable, and 0.005% by mass is further more preferable.
  • the upper limit of the modified monomer unit is 0.90% by mass, 0.50% by mass, 0.40% by mass, 0.30% by mass, 0.20% by mass, 0.15% by mass, 0.10% by mass, It is 0.05% by mass.
  • the modified monomer unit means a portion of the molecular structure of PTFE that is derived from the modified monomer.
  • each monomer unit constituting PTFE can be calculated by appropriately combining NMR, FT-IR, elemental analysis, and fluorescent X-ray analysis according to the type of monomer. Further, the content of each monomer unit constituting PTFE can also be obtained by calculation from the amount of the modified monomer added used for the polymerization.
  • the modified monomer is not particularly limited as long as it can be copolymerized with TFE, and examples thereof include fluoromonomers and non-fluoromonomers.
  • the O-CO- * or an -O- * is bonding position of the R Q2 .R Q2 representing the a hydrogen atom, and monomers represented by the representative.) the alkyl group or a nitrile group.
  • non-fluoromonomonomer examples include methyl acrylate, methyl methacrylate, ethyl acrylate, ethyl methacrylate, propyl acrylate, propyl methacrylate butyl acrylate, butyl methacrylate, hexyl methacrylate, cyclohexyl methacrylate, vinyl methacrylate, vinyl acetate, acrylic acid, methacrylic acid and acrylonitrile. , Methacrylonitrile, ethyl vinyl ether, cyclohexyl vinyl ether and the like. Of these, butyl methacrylate, vinyl acetate, and acrylic acid are preferable as the non-fluoromonomer.
  • the fluoromonomer is not particularly limited as long as it can be copolymerized with TFE, and is not particularly limited.
  • perfluoroolefin such as hexafluoropropylene [HFP]; hydrogen-containing fluoroethylene such as trifluoroethylene and vinylidene fluoride [VDF].
  • HFP hexafluoropropylene
  • VDF vinylidene fluoride
  • examples thereof include olefins; perhaloolefins such as chlorotrifluoroethylene; fluorovinyl ethers; (perfluoroalkyl) ethylenes; perfluoroallyl ethers and the like.
  • the modified monomer used may be one kind or a plurality of kinds.
  • Rf represents a perfluoroorganic group.
  • perfluoroorganic group means an organic group in which all hydrogen atoms bonded to carbon atoms are replaced with fluorine atoms.
  • the perfluoroorganic group may have ether oxygen.
  • fluorovinyl ether examples include perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) [PAVE] in which Rf is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms in the above general formula (A).
  • the number of carbon atoms of the perfluoroalkyl group is preferably 1 to 5.
  • Examples of the perfluoroalkyl group in PAVE include a perfluoromethyl group, a perfluoroethyl group, a perfluoropropyl group, a perfluorobutyl group, a perfluoropentyl group, a perfluorohexyl group and the like.
  • Rf is a perfluoro (alkoxyalkyl) group having 4 to 9 carbon atoms, and Rf is the following formula:
  • Rf is the following formula:
  • n an integer of 1 to 4.
  • perfluorovinyl ether at least one selected from the group consisting of perfluoro (methyl vinyl ether) (PMVE), perfluoro (ethyl vinyl ether) (PEVE) and perfluoro (propyl vinyl ether) (PPVE) is preferable, and PMVE is preferable. More preferred.
  • the (perfluoroalkyl) ethylene (PFAE) is not particularly limited, and examples thereof include (perfluorobutyl) ethylene (PFBE) and (perfluorohexyl) ethylene.
  • perfluoroallyl ether examples include, for example.
  • General formula: CF 2 CF-CF 2- ORf (In the formula, Rf represents a perfluoroorganic group.) Fluoromonomer represented by.
  • Rf of the above general formula is the same as the Rf of the general formula (A).
  • Rf a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms or a perfluoroalkoxyalkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms is preferable.
  • a comonomer (3) having a monomer reactivity ratio of 0.1 to 8 is also preferably exemplified.
  • PTFE particles having a small particle size can be obtained, and an aqueous dispersion having high dispersion stability can be obtained.
  • the monomer reactivity ratio in the copolymerization with TFE is the rate constant when the growth radical reacts with TFE when the growth radical is less than the repeating unit based on TFE, and the growth radical is a comonomer. It is a value divided by the rate constant when reacting. The lower this value, the more reactive the comonomer with TFE.
  • the monomer reactivity ratio can be calculated from the Feynman-Loss formula by obtaining the composition in the produced polymer immediately after the start by copolymerizing TFE and the comonomer.
  • the above copolymerization was carried out using 3600 g of deionized degassed water in a stainless steel autoclave having an internal volume of 6.0 L, 1000 ppm of ammonium perfluorooctanoate and 100 g of paraffin wax with respect to the water, at a pressure of 0.78 MPaG. It is carried out at a temperature of 70 ° C. 0.05 g, 0.1 g, 0.2 g, 0.5 g, and 1.0 g of comonomer were added to the reactor, and 0.072 g of ammonium persulfate (20 ppm with respect to water) was added to maintain the polymerization pressure of 0.78 MPaG. TFE is continuously supplied for this purpose.
  • the amount of TFE charged reaches 1000 g, stirring is stopped and decompression is performed until the reactor reaches atmospheric pressure. After cooling, the paraffin wax is separated to obtain an aqueous dispersion containing the produced polymer. The aqueous dispersion is stirred to coagulate the resulting polymer and dried at 150 ° C.
  • the composition in the obtained produced polymer is calculated by appropriately combining NMR, FT-IR, elemental analysis, and fluorescent X-ray analysis according to the type of monomer.
  • the comonomer (3) having a monomer reactivity ratio of 0.1 to 8 is preferably at least one selected from the group consisting of comomers represented by the formulas (3a) to (3d).
  • CH 2 CH-Rf 1 (3a) (In the formula, Rf 1 is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms.)
  • CF 2 CF-O-Rf 2 (3b) (In the formula, Rf 2 is a perfluoroalkyl group having 1 to 2 carbon atoms.)
  • CF 2 CF-O- (CF 2 )
  • n CF CF 2 (3c) (In the formula, n is 1 or 2.)
  • X 3 and X 4 are F, Cl or methoxy groups, and Y is the formula Y1 or Y2.
  • the content of the comonomer (3) unit is preferably in the range of 0.00001 to 1.0% by mass with respect to the total polymerization units of PTFE.
  • As the lower limit 0.0001% by mass is more preferable, 0.001% by mass is further preferable, and 0.005% by mass is even more preferable.
  • the upper limit is 0.90% by mass, 0.50% by mass, 0.40% by mass, 0.30% by mass, 0.20% by mass, 0.15% by mass, 0.10% by mass, and 0 in the order of preference. It is .08% by mass, 0.05% by mass, and 0.01% by mass.
  • hexafluoropropylene and chlorotrifluoroethylene can be obtained because the average primary particle size of the modified polytetrafluoroethylene particles is small, the aspect ratio of the primary particles is small, and an aqueous dispersion having excellent stability can be obtained.
  • At least one selected from the group consisting of vinylidene fluoride, fluoro (alkyl vinyl ether), (perfluoroalkyl) ethylene, ethylene, and a modified monomer having a functional group and a hydrophilic group that can react with radical polymerization is preferable. ..
  • aqueous dispersion of PTFE having a smaller average primary particle diameter, a smaller aspect ratio of the primary particles, and excellent dispersion stability.
  • an aqueous dispersion containing less uncoagulated polymer can be obtained.
  • the modified monomer preferably contains at least one selected from the group consisting of hexafluoropropylene, perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) and (perfluoroalkyl) ethylene. More preferably, it is selected from the group consisting of hexafluoropropylene, perfluoro (methyl vinyl ether), perfluoro (propyl vinyl ether), (perfluorobutyl) ethylene, (perfluorohexyl) ethylene, and (perfluorooctyl) ethylene. At least one of them is included.
  • the total amount of the hexafluoropropylene unit, the perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) unit and the (perfluoroalkyl) ethylene unit is preferably in the range of 0.00001 to 1% by mass with respect to the total polymerization units of PTFE.
  • As the lower limit of the total amount 0.0001% by mass is more preferable, 0.001% by mass is further preferable, and 0.005% by mass is further preferable.
  • the upper limit is 0.90 mass%, 0.50 mass%, 0.40 mass%, 0.30 mass%, 0.20 mass%, 0.15 mass%, 0.10 mass%, 0 in the preferred order. It is .08% by mass, 0.05% by mass, and 0.01% by mass.
  • the modified monomer contains a modified monomer having a functional group and a hydrophilic group capable of reacting by radical polymerization (hereinafter referred to as "modified monomer (A)").
  • PTFE particles having a small primary particle diameter can be obtained, and an aqueous dispersion having high dispersion stability can be obtained.
  • the amount of uncoagulated polymer can be reduced.
  • the aspect ratio of the primary particles can be reduced.
  • the amount of the modified monomer (A) used is preferably more than 0.1 ppm of the aqueous medium, more preferably more than 0.5 ppm, and more than 1.0 ppm. It is even more preferably 5 ppm or more, and particularly preferably 10 ppm or more. If the amount of the modified monomer (A) used is too small, the average primary particle size of the obtained PTFE may not be reduced.
  • the amount of the modified monomer (A) used may be in the above range, but the upper limit can be, for example, 5000 ppm. Further, in the above production method, the modified monomer (A) may be added to the system during the reaction in order to improve the stability of the aqueous dispersion during or after the reaction.
  • the modified monomer (A) is highly water-soluble, even if the unreacted modified monomer (A) remains in the aqueous dispersion, it can be easily removed in the concentration step or the coagulation / washing step.
  • the modified monomer (A) is incorporated into the produced polymer in the process of polymerization, but the concentration of the modified monomer (A) in the polymerization system itself is low and the amount incorporated into the polymer is small, so that the heat resistance of PTFE is lowered. There is no problem of coloring after firing.
  • hydrophilic group in the modified monomer (A) examples include -NH 2 , -PO 3 M, -PO (OM) 2 , -OPO 3 M, -OPO (OM) 2 , -SO 3 M, and -OSO 3.
  • M, in -COOM each formula, (M has H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, which may imidazolium substituted, which may have a substituent pyridinium or substituent which may be a phosphonium, R 7 is H or an organic group and may be the same or different. bonded to any two Tsugaotagai, may form a ring.
  • the hydrophilic As the group, -SO 3 M or -COOM is preferable.
  • an alkyl group is preferable.
  • an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, and H or C 1 is preferable.
  • the organic group of -4 is more preferable, and the alkyl group of H or C 1-4 is further preferable.
  • the metal atom include monovalent and divalent metal atoms, and examples thereof include alkali metals (Group 1) and alkaline earth metals (Group 2), with Na, K or Li being preferable.
  • Examples of the "functional group capable of reacting by radical polymerization" in the modified monomer (A) include a group having an ethylenically unsaturated bond such as a vinyl group and an allyl group.
  • the linking group R include linking groups as R a, which will be described later.
  • the modified monomer (A) Since the modified monomer (A) has a functional group capable of reacting by radical polymerization, when used in the polymerization, it reacts with TFE at the initial stage of the polymerization reaction and has a hydrophilic group derived from the modified monomer (A) and is stable. It is presumed that particles with high properties are formed. Therefore, it is considered that the number of particles increases when the polymerization is carried out in the presence of the modified monomer (A).
  • one kind of the modified monomer (A) may be present, or two or more kinds of the modified monomer (A) may be present.
  • a compound having an unsaturated bond can be used as the modified monomer (A).
  • hydrophilic group examples include -NH 2 , -PO 3 M, -PO (OM) 2 , -OPO 3 M, -OPO (OM) 2 , -SO 3 M, -OSO 3 M, and -COOM (each).
  • M, H a metal atom, NR 7 4, which may imidazolium substituted, may have a good pyridinium or substituted group which may have a substituent phosphonium
  • R Reference numeral 7 denotes H or an organic group, which may be the same or different. Any two of them may be bonded to each other to form a ring).
  • -SO 3 M or -COOM is particularly preferable.
  • An alkyl group is preferable as the organic group of R 7 .
  • R 7 an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, an organic group of H or C 1-4 is more preferable, and an alkyl group of H or C 1-4 is further preferable.
  • the metal atom include monovalent and divalent metal atoms, and examples thereof include alkali metals (Group 1) and alkaline earth metals (Group 2), with Na, K or Li being preferable.
  • Ra is a linking group.
  • linking group refers to a divalent linking group.
  • the linking group may be a single bond and preferably contains at least one carbon atom, and the number of carbon atoms may be 2 or more, 4 or more, or 8 or more. It may be 10 or more, and may be 20 or more. The upper limit is not limited, but may be 100 or less, and may be 50 or less, for example.
  • the linking group may be chain or branched, cyclic or acyclic, saturated or unsaturated, substituted or unsubstituted, and may optionally be one or more selected from the group consisting of sulfur, oxygen, and nitrogen.
  • the linking group does not contain a carbon atom and may be a catenary heteroatom such as oxygen, sulfur or nitrogen.
  • the Ra is preferably a catenary heteroatom such as oxygen, sulfur, or nitrogen, or a divalent organic group.
  • the hydrogen atom bonded to the carbon atom may be replaced with a halogen other than fluorine, for example, chlorine, and may or may not contain a double bond.
  • R a is linear and may be either branched, may be either cyclic or acyclic.
  • Ra may contain a functional group (for example, an ester, an ether, a ketone, an amine, a halide, etc.).
  • Ra may also be a non-fluorinated divalent organic group or a partially fluorinated or perfluorinated divalent organic group.
  • a, b, c and d are independently at least one or more.
  • a, b, c and d may be independently 2 or more, 3 or more, 4 or more, 10 or more, and 20 or more.
  • the upper limit of a, b, c and d is, for example, 100.
  • X 6 is H, F or CF 3 , respectively, e is an integer of 0 to 3, f is an integer of 0 to 3, g is 0 or 1, and h is.
  • X 7 are each independently H, F or CF 3
  • a divalent group represented by (e is an integer of 0 to 3, g is 0 or 1, h is 0 or 1, and i is 0 or 1) is also preferred.
  • a divalent group represented by (0 or 1, i is 0 or 1, and Z 1 and Z 2 are independently F or CF 3 ) is also preferable, and in formula (t1), More preferably, Z 1 and Z 2 are F on one side and CF 3 on the other side.
  • the compound represented by the general formula (4) has a CF bond and does not have a CH bond, except for the hydrophilic group (Y 3 ). That is, in the general formula (4), it is preferable that all of X i , X j , and X k are F, and Ra is a perfluoroalkylene group having 1 or more carbon atoms, and the perfluoroalkylene group is preferably a perfluoroalkylene group having 1 or more carbon atoms. , Chained or branched, cyclic or acyclic, and may contain at least one catenary heteroatom. The number of carbon atoms of the perfluoroalkylene group may be 2 to 20, and may be 4 to 18.
  • the compound represented by the general formula (4) may be partially fluorinated. That is, the compound represented by the general formula (4), with the exception of hydrophilic group (Y 3), having at least one hydrogen atom bonded to a carbon atom, having at least one fluorine atom attached to a carbon atom It is also preferable.
  • the compound represented by the general formula (4) is also preferably a compound represented by the following formula (4a).
  • CF 2 CF-O-Rf 0- Y 3 (4a)
  • Y 3 is a hydrophilic group and Rf 0 is hyperfluorinated and may have a chain or branched, cyclic or acyclic structure, saturated or unsaturated, substituted or unsubstituted.
  • a perfluorinated divalent linking group optionally additionally containing one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of sulfur, oxygen, and nitrogen.
  • the compound represented by the general formula (4) is also preferably a compound represented by the following formula (4b).
  • CH 2 CH-O-Rf 0- Y 3 (4b) (In the formula, Y 3 is a hydrophilic group and Rf 0 is a perfluorinated divalent linking group defined by the formula (4a).)
  • Y 3 is one of the preferable forms having ⁇ OSO 3 M.
  • Y 3 is ⁇ SO 3 M.
  • M is the same as above.
  • Y 3 is also one of preferred embodiments it is -COOM.
  • Y 3 is ⁇ OPO 3 M or ⁇ OP (O) (OM) 2 .
  • Y 3 is ⁇ PO 3 M or ⁇ P (O) (OM) 2 .
  • Examples of the compound represented by the general formula (4) include the following general formula (5):
  • CX 2 CY (-CZ 2 -ORf-Y 3 ) (5)
  • X is the same or different, -H or -F
  • Y is -H, -F, an alkyl group or a fluorine-containing alkyl group
  • Z is the same or different, -H,-.
  • Y 3 is monomer represented by the same as), and the following general formula (7).:
  • CX 2 CY (-Rf-Y 3 ) (7)
  • X is the same or different, -H or -F
  • Y is -H, -F, an alkyl group or a fluorine-containing alkyl group
  • Rf is a fluorine-containing alkylene group having 1 to 40 carbon atoms.
  • .Y 3 is a fluorine-containing alkylene group having ether bond having 2-100 carbon atoms are the same as defined above, and.
  • the fluorine-containing alkylene group having an ether bond having 2 to 100 carbon atoms is an alkylene group that does not contain a structure in which an oxygen atom is a terminal and contains an ether bond between carbon carbons.
  • X is ⁇ H or ⁇ F. Both of X may be -F, and at least one may be -H. For example, one may be -F and the other may be -H, or both may be -H.
  • Y is an —H, —F, an alkyl group or a fluorine-containing alkyl group.
  • the alkyl group may be an alkyl group containing no fluorine atom and may have 1 or more carbon atoms.
  • the alkyl group preferably has 6 or less carbon atoms, more preferably 4 or less, and even more preferably 3 or less.
  • the fluorine-containing alkyl group is an alkyl group containing at least one fluorine atom, and may have 1 or more carbon atoms.
  • the fluorine-containing alkyl group preferably has 6 or less carbon atoms, more preferably 4 or less, and even more preferably 3 or less.
  • Y, -H, -F or -CF 3 is preferable, and -F is more preferable.
  • Z is the same or different, and is an —H, —F, an alkyl group or a fluoroalkyl group.
  • the alkyl group may be an alkyl group containing no fluorine atom and may have 1 or more carbon atoms.
  • the alkyl group preferably has 6 or less carbon atoms, more preferably 4 or less, and even more preferably 3 or less.
  • the fluorine-containing alkyl group is an alkyl group containing at least one fluorine atom, and may have 1 or more carbon atoms.
  • the fluorine-containing alkyl group preferably has 6 or less carbon atoms, more preferably 4 or less, and even more preferably 3 or less.
  • -H, -F or -CF 3 is preferable, and -F is more preferable.
  • X may be -H and Y and Z may be -F.
  • the Rf is a fluorine-containing alkylene group having 1 to 40 carbon atoms or a fluorine-containing alkylene group having an ether bond having 2 to 100 carbon atoms.
  • the fluorine-containing alkylene group preferably has 2 or more carbon atoms. Further, 30 or less is preferable, 20 or less is more preferable, and 10 or less is further preferable.
  • fluorinated alkylene group -CF 2 -, - CH 2 CF 2 -, - CF 2 CF 2 -, - CF 2 CH 2 -, - CF 2 CF 2 CH 2 -, - CF (CF 3) - , -CF (CF 3) CF 2 -, - CF (CF 3) CH 2 - and the like.
  • the fluorine-containing alkylene group is preferably a perfluoroalkylene group.
  • the fluorine-containing alkylene group having an ether bond preferably has 3 or more carbon atoms.
  • the number of carbon atoms of the fluorine-containing alkylene group having an ether bond is preferably 60 or less, more preferably 30 or less, and even more preferably 12 or less.
  • Examples of the fluorine-containing alkylene group having an ether bond include the following formula: (In the equation, Z 1 is F or CF 3 ; Z 2 and Z 3 are H or F, respectively; Z 4 is H, F or CF 3 ; p1 + q1 + r1 is an integer of 1 to 10; s1 is 0 or 1; t1 is 0. It is also preferable that it is a divalent group represented by (an integer of ⁇ 5).
  • n is an integer of 1 to 10
  • n is an integer of 1 to 10
  • Y 3 is, -COOM, -SO 3 M or -OSO 3 M
  • M is, H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, good imidazolium be substituted, substituted good phosphonium have a good pyridinium or substituted group which may have a group
  • R 7 is H or an organic group and may be the same or different. bonded to any two Tsugaotagai, A ring may be formed.
  • An alkyl group is preferable as the organic group of R 7 .
  • R 7 an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, an organic group of H or C 1-4 is more preferable, and an alkyl group of H or C 1-4 is further preferable.
  • the metal atom examples include alkali metals (Group 1) and alkaline earth metals (Group 2), and Na, K or Li are preferable.
  • M -H, preferably is a metal atom or -NR 7 4, -H, alkali metal (Group 1), alkaline earth metal (Group 2) or -NR 7 4, more preferably, -H, -Na , -K, -Li or -NH 4 are more preferable, -Na, preferably from -K or -NH 4 further particularly preferred -Na or -NH 4, -NH 4 is most preferred.
  • Y 3 preferably -COOM or -SO 3 M, -COOM is more preferable.
  • the monomer represented by the general formula (5) is preferably the monomer (5a) represented by the following general formula (5a).
  • CH 2 CF (-CF 2- O-Rf-Y 3 ) (5a) (Wherein, Rf and Y 3 are as defined above.)
  • the monomer represented by the general formula (5a) has the following formula.
  • Z 1 is F or CF 3 ;
  • Z 2 and Z 3 are H or F, respectively;
  • Z 4 is H, F or CF 3 ;
  • p1 + q1 + r1 is an integer of 0 to 10;
  • s1 is 0 or 1;
  • t1 is 0.
  • the integers of up to 5 and Y 3 are the same as described above. However, when Z 3 and Z 4 are both H, p1 + q1 + r1 + s1 is not 0). More specifically
  • Etc. are preferably mentioned, among them
  • the monomer represented by the general formula (5) is preferably the monomer (5b) represented by the following general formula (5b).
  • CX 2 2 CFCF 2- O- (CF (CF 3 ) CF 2 O) n5- CF (CF 3 ) -Y 3 (5b) (In the equation, each X 2 is the same and represents F or H. N5 represents 0 or an integer of 1 to 10, and Y 3 is the same as the above definition.)
  • the above n5 is preferably 0 or an integer of 1 to 5, more preferably 0, 1 or 2, and 0 or 1 in terms of the stability of the obtained aqueous dispersion. Is more preferable.
  • the Y 3 is preferably -COOM from the stability of the proper water solubility and an aqueous dispersion is obtained, the M is less likely to remain as an impurity, the heat resistance of the obtained molded article is improved In terms of points, it is preferably H or NH 4 .
  • examples of the monomer represented by the general formula (5) include a monomer represented by the following general formula (5c).
  • CF 2 CFCF 2 -ORf-Y 3 (5c) (Wherein, Rf and Y 3 are as defined above)
  • X is ⁇ H or ⁇ F. Both of X may be -F, and at least one may be -H. For example, one may be -F and the other may be -H, or both may be -H.
  • Y is an —H, —F, an alkyl group or a fluorine-containing alkyl group.
  • the alkyl group may be an alkyl group containing no fluorine atom and may have 1 or more carbon atoms.
  • the alkyl group preferably has 6 or less carbon atoms, more preferably 4 or less, and even more preferably 3 or less.
  • the fluorine-containing alkyl group is an alkyl group containing at least one fluorine atom, and may have 1 or more carbon atoms.
  • the fluorine-containing alkyl group preferably has 6 or less carbon atoms, more preferably 4 or less, and even more preferably 3 or less.
  • Y, -H, -F or -CF 3 is preferable, and -F is more preferable.
  • X and Y contains a fluorine atom.
  • X may be -H and Y and Z may be -F.
  • the Rf is a fluorine-containing alkylene group having 1 to 40 carbon atoms or a fluorine-containing alkylene group having an ether bond having 2 to 100 carbon atoms.
  • the fluorine-containing alkylene group preferably has 2 or more carbon atoms.
  • the number of carbon atoms of the fluorine-containing alkylene group is preferably 30 or less, more preferably 20 or less, and even more preferably 10 or less.
  • fluorinated alkylene group -CF 2 -, - CH 2 CF 2 -, - CF 2 CF 2 -, - CF 2 CH 2 -, - CF 2 CF 2 CH 2 -, - CF (CF 3) - , -CF (CF 3) CF 2 -, - CF (CF 3) CH 2 - and the like.
  • the fluorine-containing alkylene group is preferably a perfluoroalkylene group.
  • Y 3 is, -COOM, -SO 3 M or -OSO 3 M
  • M is, H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, good imidazolium be substituted, substituted good phosphonium have a good pyridinium or substituted group which may have a group
  • R 7 is H or an organic group and may be the same or different. bonded to any two Tsugaotagai, A ring may be formed.
  • An alkyl group is preferable as the organic group of R 7 .
  • R 7 an organic group of H or C 1-10 is preferable, an organic group of H or C 1-4 is more preferable, and an alkyl group of H or C 1-4 is further preferable.
  • the metal atom examples include alkali metals (Group 1) and alkaline earth metals (Group 2), and Na, K or Li are preferable.
  • M -H, preferably is a metal atom or -NR 7 4, -H, alkali metal (Group 1), alkaline earth metal (Group 2) or -NR 7 4, more preferably, -H, -Na , -K, -Li or -NH 4 are more preferable, -Na, preferably from -K or -NH 4 further particularly preferred -Na or -NH 4, -NH 4 is most preferred.
  • Y 3 preferably -COOM or -SO 3 M, -COOM is more preferable.
  • the monomer represented by the general formula (6) is selected from the group consisting of the monomers represented by the following general formulas (6a), (6b), (6c), (6d) and (6e). At least one type is preferable.
  • CF 2 CF-O- (CF 2 ) n1- Y 3 (6a) (In the formula, n1 represents an integer from 1 to 10 and is the same as the above definition.)
  • CF 2 CF-O- (CF 2 C (CF 3 ) F) n2- Y 3 (6b) (Wherein, n2 represents an integer of 1 ⁇ 5, Y 3 is as previously defined.)
  • CF 2 CF-O- (CFX 1) n3 -Y 3 (6c) (In the formula, X 1 represents F or CF 3 , n 3 represents an integer of 1 to 10, and Y 3 is the same as the above definition.)
  • CF 2 CF-O- (CF 2 CFX 1 O) n4- (CF 2 ) n6- Y 3
  • n1 is preferably an integer of 5 or less, and more preferably an integer of 2 or less.
  • the Y 3 are points obtained stability proper water solubility and an aqueous dispersion is preferably -COOM, M is little tendency toward remaining as an impurity, that the heat resistance of the resulting molded article is improved Therefore, it is preferably H or NH 4 .
  • n2 is in terms of stability of the resulting aqueous dispersion is preferably 3 or less an integer
  • Y 3 is the stability of the proper water solubility and an aqueous dispersion obtained In that respect, it is preferably ⁇ COOM, and M is less likely to remain as an impurity, and H or NH 4 is preferable in that the heat resistance of the obtained molded product is improved.
  • n3 is preferably 5 or less integer in terms of water-soluble
  • the Y 3 is in that the stability of the proper water solubility and an aqueous dispersion is obtained
  • -COOM is preferably H or NH 4 in terms of improving dispersion stability.
  • the above X 1 is preferably ⁇ CF 3 in terms of the stability of the aqueous dispersion, and the above n4 is preferably an integer of 5 or less in terms of water solubility.
  • the above Y 3 is preferably ⁇ COOM in that appropriate water solubility and stability of the aqueous dispersion can be obtained, and the above M is preferably H or NH 4 .
  • n5 is preferably 5 or less integer in terms of water-soluble
  • the Y 3 are in that excellent sedimentation stability of the proper water solubility and composition are obtained - It is preferably COOM, and the above M is preferably H or NH 4 .
  • Rf is preferably a fluorine-containing alkylene group having 1 to 40 carbon atoms. In the general formula (7), it is preferable that at least one of X and Y contains a fluorine atom.
  • the Y 3 are, -SO 3 M or -COOM is preferably, M, H, a metal atom, NR 7 4, which may imidazolium substituted, pyridinium which may have a substituent or It is preferably phosphonium which may have a substituent.
  • R 7 represents H or an organic group.
  • the above n1 is preferably an integer of 5 or less, and more preferably an integer of 2 or less.
  • the Y 3 are points obtained stability proper water solubility and an aqueous dispersion is preferably -COOM, M is little tendency toward remaining as an impurity, that the heat resistance of the resulting molded article is improved Therefore, it is preferably H or NH 4 .
  • n2 is in terms of stability of the resulting aqueous dispersion is preferably 3 or less an integer
  • Y 3 is the stability of the proper water solubility and an aqueous dispersion obtained In that respect, it is preferably ⁇ COOM
  • M is preferably H or NH 4 in that it does not easily remain as an impurity and the heat resistance of the obtained molded product is improved.
  • the modified monomer preferably contains the modified monomer (A), and has a general formula (5a), a general formula (5b), a general formula (6a), a general formula (6b), a general formula (6c), and a general formula. It is preferable to include at least one selected from the group consisting of the compounds represented by (6d), and it is more preferable to include the compound represented by the general formula (5a) or the general formula (5b).
  • the content of the polymerization unit based on the modified monomer (A) is preferably in the range of 0.00001 to 1.0% by mass with respect to PTFE.
  • the lower limit 0.0001% by mass is more preferable, 0.001% by mass is further preferable, and 0.005% by mass is even more preferable.
  • the upper limit is 0.90% by mass, 0.50% by mass, 0.40% by mass, 0.30% by mass, 0.20% by mass, 0.15% by mass, 0.10% by mass, and 0 in the order of preference. It is .08% by mass, 0.05% by mass, and 0.01% by mass.
  • the PTFE may have a core-shell structure.
  • the core-shell structure is a conventionally known structure, and is a structure of primary particles in an aqueous dispersion that can be produced by the method described in US Pat. No. 6,841,594.
  • Examples of the polytetrafluoroethylene having a core-shell structure include a core-shell structure including a core portion of a TFE homopolymer and a shell portion of a modified PTFE, and a core-shell structure including a core portion of a modified PTFE and a shell portion of a TFE homopolymer.
  • a core-shell structure including a core portion of modified PTFE and a shell portion of modified PTFE having a monomer composition different from that of the modified PTFE constituting the core portion.
  • TFE and, if necessary, a modified monomer are first polymerized to produce a core portion (TFE homopolymer or modified PTFE), and then TFE and, if necessary, a modified monomer are polymerized. It can be obtained by producing a shell portion (TFE homopolymer or modified PTFE).
  • the shell portion means a portion constituting a predetermined thickness from the surface of the PTFE primary particle to the inside of the particle, and the core portion means a portion constituting the inside of the shell portion.
  • the core-shell structure includes (1) a core portion and a shell portion having different monomer compositions, and (2) a core portion and a shell portion having the same monomer composition and both portions. (3) The core portion and the shell portion have different monomer compositions, and the number average molecular weights of both portions are also different.
  • the content of the modified monomer in the shell portion is preferably 0.00001 to 1.0% by mass. It is more preferably 0.0001% by mass or more, further preferably 0.001% by mass or more, and even more preferably 0.01% by mass or more. Further, it is more preferably 0.50% by mass or less, and further preferably 0.30% by mass or less.
  • the content of the modified monomer in the core portion is preferably 0.00001 to 1.0% by mass. It is more preferably 0.0001% by mass or more, and further preferably 0.001% by mass or more. Further, it is more preferably 0.50% by mass or less, and further preferably 0.30% by mass or less.
  • the average primary particle size of the PTFE is preferably 500 nm or less, more preferably 400 nm or less, and further preferably 350 nm or less.
  • PTFE having a small average primary particle size can be obtained.
  • the lower limit of the average primary particle diameter is not particularly limited, but may be, for example, 50 nm or 100 nm. From the viewpoint of molecular weight, for example, in the case of high molecular weight PTFE, it is preferably 100 nm or more, and more preferably 150 nm or more.
  • the average primary particle size can be measured by a dynamic light scattering method.
  • the average primary particle size was adjusted to a solid content concentration of about 1.0% by mass to prepare a PTFE aqueous dispersion, and the dynamic light scattering method was used to make the solvent (water) have a refractive index of 1.
  • the viscosity of 3328 and the solvent (water) is 0.8878 mPa ⁇ s, and can be measured 70 times in total.
  • ELSZ-1000S manufactured by Otsuka Electronics Co., Ltd.
  • the aspect ratio of the primary particles is preferably 1.45 or less.
  • the aspect ratio is more preferably 1.40 or less, further preferably 1.35 or less, further preferably 1.30 or less, particularly preferably 1.25 or less, particularly preferably 1.20 or less, and 1.15 or less. Is particularly preferable.
  • the aspect ratio is 400, which is obtained by observing a PTFE aqueous dispersion diluted to a solid content concentration of about 1% by mass with a scanning electron microscope (SEM) and randomly extracting 400. Image processing is performed on one or more particles, and the average of the ratios of the major axis to the minor axis is used to obtain the image.
  • SEM scanning electron microscope
  • the above aspect ratio is obtained by irradiating the modified PTFE powder with an electron beam, adding it to an aqueous solution of a fluorine-based surfactant, and redispersing it with ultrasonic waves to obtain a modified PTFE aqueous dispersion. Can be done. From this modified PTFE aqueous dispersion, the aspect ratio is determined by the same method as the method for measuring with the aqueous dispersion.
  • the standard specific gravity (SSG) and the melt viscosity (MV) used as an index of the molecular weight are not particularly limited.
  • the PTFE powder obtained by the production method of the present disclosure preferably has an average particle size (average secondary particle size) of 100 to 2000 ⁇ m.
  • the lower limit of the average secondary particle diameter is more preferably 200 ⁇ m or more, and further preferably 300 ⁇ m or more.
  • the upper limit of the average secondary particle size is preferably 1000 ⁇ m or less, more preferably 800 ⁇ m or less, and particularly preferably 700 ⁇ m or less.
  • the average particle size is a value measured in accordance with JIS K 6891.
  • the standard specific gravity (SSG) of the above-mentioned PTFE is preferably 2.280 or less, more preferably 2.200, further preferably 2.190, and further preferably 2.180 or less. preferable. Further, it is preferably 2.130 or more.
  • the SSG is measured by a water substitution method based on ASTM D 792 using a sample molded according to ASTM D 4895-89.
  • the peak temperature of the PTFE is preferably 348 ° C. or lower, more preferably 346 ° C. or lower, further preferably 344 ° C. or lower, still more preferably 342 ° C. or lower, and 340 ° C. or lower. Is particularly preferable.
  • the peak temperature is a value measured by the following method. Approximately 10 mg of powder that has not been heated to a temperature of 300 ° C. or higher is precisely weighed, stored in a dedicated aluminum pan, and measured using a TG / DTA (differential thermal weight simultaneous measuring device). The peak temperature was set to a temperature corresponding to the maximum value of the differential thermal (DTA) curve by raising the temperature of the aluminum pan in an atmospheric atmosphere in a temperature range of 25 ° C. to 600 ° C. under the condition of 10 ° C./min.
  • DTA differential thermal
  • the extrusion pressure of the PTFE is preferably 50.0 MPaG or less, more preferably 40.0 MPaG or less, preferably 5.0 MPaG or more, more preferably 10.0 MPaG or more, and 15 More preferably, it is 0.0 MPaG or more.
  • the extrusion pressure is a value obtained by the following method. To 100 g of PTFE powder, 21.7 g of a lubricant (trade name: Isopar H (registered trademark), manufactured by Exxon Co., Ltd.) is added, and the mixture is mixed in a glass bottle at room temperature for 3 minutes. The glass bottle is then left at room temperature (25 ° C.) for at least 1 hour prior to extrusion to obtain a lubricating resin.
  • a lubricant trade name: Isopar H (registered trademark)
  • the lubricating resin is paste-extruded through an orifice (diameter 2.5 mm, land length 11 mm, introduction angle 30 °) at a reduction ratio of 100: 1 at room temperature to obtain a uniform beading (extruded product).
  • the extrusion speed that is, the ram speed, is 20 inches / minute (51 cm / minute).
  • the extrusion pressure is a value obtained by measuring the load when the extrusion load is in equilibrium in paste extrusion and dividing by the cross-sectional area of the cylinder used for paste extrusion.
  • the PTFE usually has stretchability, fibrillation properties and non-molten secondary processability.
  • the non-melt secondary processability means a property that the melt flow rate cannot be measured at a temperature higher than the crystallization melting point, that is, a property that does not easily flow even in the melting temperature region, in accordance with ASTM D 1238 and D 2116.
  • the above-mentioned carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant can be used within the range of use in the above-mentioned production method of the present disclosure.
  • the concentration of the surfactant is not particularly limited as long as it is within the above range, but is usually added at the critical micelle concentration (CMC) or less at the start of polymerization. If the amount added is large, needle-like particles having a large aspect ratio are generated, and the aqueous dispersion becomes gel-like and the stability is impaired.
  • the lower limit of the amount of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant used is preferably 0.0001% by mass, more preferably 0.001% by mass, still more preferably 0.01% by mass, particularly with respect to the aqueous medium. It is preferably 0.1% by mass.
  • the upper limit of the amount of the surfactant used is preferably 10% by mass, more preferably 5% by mass, still more preferably 3% by mass, and particularly preferably 2% by mass with respect to the aqueous medium.
  • the above-mentioned carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant may be added to the reaction vessel all at once before the start of polymerization, may be added all at once after the start of polymerization, or may be divided into a plurality of times during the polymerization. It may be added continuously, or it may be added continuously during the polymerization.
  • a persulfate, an organic peroxide, or a mixture thereof can be used as the radical polymerization initiator.
  • the persulfate include ammonium persulfate, potassium persulfate and the like.
  • the organic peroxide include disuccinic acid peroxide and diglutaric acid peroxide.
  • a redox initiator that combines an oxidizing agent and a reducing agent.
  • the oxidizing agent include persulfate, organic peroxide, potassium permanganate, manganese triacetate, ammonium cerium nitrate and the like.
  • the reducing agent include bromate, diimine, oxalic acid and the like.
  • the persulfate include ammonium persulfate and potassium persulfate.
  • a copper salt and an iron salt to the combination of the redox initiator.
  • the copper salt include copper (II) sulfate
  • the iron salt include iron (II) sulfate.
  • Examples of the redox initiator include potassium permanganate / oxalic acid, potassium permanganate / ammonium oxalate, manganese triacetate / oxalic acid, manganese triacetate / ammonium oxalate, ammonium cerium nitrate / oxalic acid, ammonium cerium nitrate /. Examples thereof include ammonium oxalate, and potassium permanganate / oxalic acid is preferable.
  • a redox initiator either an oxidizing agent or a reducing agent may be charged in advance in the polymerization tank, and then the other may be continuously or intermittently added to initiate polymerization.
  • potassium permanganate / oxalic acid it is preferable to charge oxalic acid in the polymerization tank and continuously add potassium permanganate to the oxalic acid.
  • chain transfer agents can be used, and for example, saturated hydrocarbons such as methane, ethane, propane and butane, and halogenated hydrocarbons such as chloromethane, dichloromethane and difluoroethane. , Alcohols such as methanol and ethanol, hydrogen and the like, but those in a gaseous state at normal temperature and pressure are preferable.
  • the amount of the chain transfer agent used is usually 1 to 10000 ppm, preferably 1 to 5000 ppm, based on the total amount of TFE supplied.
  • the amount used may be 1 to 1000 ppm or 1 to 500 ppm.
  • a dispersion stabilizer of the reaction system 100 parts by mass of a saturated hydrocarbon having 12 or more carbon atoms which is substantially inert to the reaction and becomes liquid under the above-mentioned reaction conditions is used. It can also be used in an amount of 2 to 10 parts by mass. Further, ammonium carbonate, ammonium phosphate or the like may be added as a buffer for adjusting the pH during the reaction.
  • an aqueous dispersion having a solid content concentration of 1.0 to 70% by mass and an average primary particle size of 50 to 500 nm can be obtained.
  • the aqueous dispersion contains the surfactant and the fluoropolymer. Further, by using the above-mentioned surfactant, an aqueous dispersion having particles made of a TFE polymer having a fine particle diameter of 0.5 ⁇ m or less can be obtained.
  • the polymerization step in the production of PTFE is a step (I) of obtaining particles containing a polymerization unit based on TFE, and a step of polymerizing TFE in an aqueous medium containing the particles obtained in step (I) to obtain PTFE. It is also preferable that the step includes (II).
  • the step includes (II).
  • the step (II) may be carried out using the aqueous dispersion containing the particles obtained in the step (I) as it is. Further, the aqueous dispersion containing the particles obtained in the step (I) may be diluted or concentrated to carry out the step (II). The dilution or concentration may be carried out as it is in the reactor, or the aqueous dispersion containing the particles obtained in the step (I) may be recovered from the reactor. Therefore, the polymerization step may further include a step of recovering the aqueous dispersion containing the particles obtained in the step (I) after the step (I) and before the step (II).
  • a step of adjusting the aqueous dispersion containing the particles obtained in the step (I) to less than 50 ° C, less than 30 ° C, or less than 10 ° C may be included. ..
  • the stirring can be stopped once after the step (I), and then the stirring can be restarted to continue the step (II).
  • the stirring may be stopped in some cases, the pressure in the reactor is changed, the stirring is restarted, and then the stirring is continued. Step (II) can be performed.
  • step (I) the pressure of the reactor is depressurized to atmospheric pressure, each monomer is charged into the reactor, and then the step (II) is continued. You may. After the step (I), the polymerization temperature can be changed and the step (II) can be continued.
  • the polymerization step includes the step (II)
  • the number of particles can be increased by using a redox initiator.
  • the redox initiator is charged in the step (I) and then the polymerization initiator in the step (II) is charged to continuously produce the product. Can be done. Examples of the redox initiator include those described above.
  • a radical polymerization initiator may be used in the step (I).
  • the number of particles of the above particles can be increased by using a radical polymerization initiator.
  • the radical polymerization initiator is charged in the step (I) and then the polymerization initiator in the step (II) is charged to continuously produce the product. be able to. Examples of the radical polymerization initiator will be described later, but in step (I), ammonium persulfate is preferable. In step (II), disuccinic acid peroxide is preferable. Further, in the step (II), it is preferable that the radical polymerization initiator is continuously or intermittently charged.
  • the step (I) is preferably a step of obtaining an aqueous dispersion having a particle concentration of 20.0% by mass or less.
  • the solid content concentration is more preferably 15.0% by mass or less, further preferably 10.0% by mass or less, still more preferably 8.0% by mass or less, and particularly preferably 5.0% by mass. % Or less.
  • the solid content concentration is preferably 0.1% by mass or more, more preferably 0.3% by mass or more, further preferably 0.5% by mass or more, still more preferably 0.8% by mass or more, and 1.0. Mass% or more is particularly preferable, and 1.5% by mass or more is particularly preferable.
  • the particles may be a TFE homopolymer consisting of only TFE-based polymerization units, a TFE-based polymerization unit of 99.0% by mass or more, and a modified monomer-based polymerization unit of 1.0% by mass.
  • It may be modified PTFE as follows.
  • the modified PTFE preferably has a polymerization unit based on the modified monomer (hereinafter, also referred to as “modified monomer unit”) in the range of 0.00001 to 1.0% by mass.
  • modified monomer unit As the lower limit of the modified monomer unit, 0.0001% by mass is more preferable, 0.001% by mass is further preferable, 0.005% by mass is further more preferable, and 0.009% by mass is particularly preferable.
  • the upper limit of the modified monomer unit is preferably 0.90% by mass, more preferably 0.50% by mass, further preferably 0.40% by mass, still more preferably 0.30% by mass, and 0.10% by mass. It is particularly preferable, and 0.05% by mass is particularly preferable.
  • the particles obtained in the above step (I) preferably have an average primary particle diameter of 300 nm or less, more preferably 200 nm or less, and further preferably 150 nm or less.
  • the average primary particle diameter is preferably 0.1 nm or more, more preferably 1.0 nm or more, and further preferably 3.0 nm or more.
  • the average primary particle size can be measured by a dynamic light scattering method. The average primary particle size was adjusted to a solid content concentration of about 1.0% by mass to prepare a PTFE aqueous dispersion, and the dynamic light scattering method was used to make the solvent (water) have a refractive index of 1.
  • the viscosity of 3328 and the solvent (water) is 0.8878 mPa ⁇ s, and can be measured 70 times in total.
  • the dynamic light scattering method for example, ELSZ-1000S (manufactured by Otsuka Electronics Co., Ltd.) can be used.
  • the aqueous medium is a reaction medium for polymerizing and means a liquid containing water.
  • the aqueous medium is not particularly limited as long as it contains water, and water and a fluorine-free organic solvent such as alcohol, ether, and ketone, and / or a fluorine-containing organic solvent having a boiling point of 40 ° C. or lower are used. And may be included.
  • the aqueous medium in the step (II) preferably contains an aqueous medium contained in the aqueous dispersion containing the particles obtained in the step (I). In addition to the aqueous medium contained in the aqueous dispersion containing the particles, another aqueous medium may be added.
  • the polymerization temperature and polymerization pressure in the step (II) are appropriately determined by the type of monomer used, the target molecular weight of PTFE, and the reaction rate.
  • the polymerization temperature is preferably 10 to 150 ° C.
  • the polymerization temperature is more preferably 30 ° C. or higher, and even more preferably 50 ° C. or higher. Further, 120 ° C. or lower is more preferable, and 100 ° C. or lower is further preferable.
  • the polymerization pressure is preferably 0.05 to 10 MPaG.
  • the polymerization pressure is more preferably 0.3 MPaG or more, further preferably 0.5 MPaG or more, still more preferably 5.0 MPaG or less, still more preferably 3.0 MPaG or less. In particular, from the viewpoint of improving the obtained amount, 1.0 MPaG or more is preferable, and 2.0 MPaG or more is more preferable.
  • the above step (II) may be performed in the presence of a carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant, or may be performed in the absence of a carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • the step (II) is preferably a step of polymerizing TFE in an aqueous medium containing the particles in the presence of a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant is preferably 0.0001 to 15% by mass with respect to the aqueous medium.
  • a more preferable lower limit is 0.001% by mass, and a more preferable upper limit is 1% by mass. If it is less than 0.0001% by mass, the dispersion force may be insufficient, and if it exceeds 15% by mass, the effect commensurate with the amount added cannot be obtained.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant added is appropriately determined depending on the type of monomer used, the target molecular weight of PTFE, and the like.
  • the above-mentioned carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant may be added collectively into the reaction vessel before the start of polymerization, may be added collectively after the start of polymerization, or may be divided into a plurality of times during the polymerization. It may be added continuously, or it may be added continuously during the polymerization.
  • the step (II) preferably includes a step of continuously adding a carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant.
  • the continuous addition of the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant is, for example, by adding the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant not all at once but over time and without interruption or in divisions. is there.
  • an aqueous dispersion having a smaller average primary particle size and more excellent stability can be obtained.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant at the start of polymerization is preferably 1 ppb or more with respect to the aqueous medium.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant at the start of polymerization is preferably 10 ppb or more, more preferably 50 ppb or more, still more preferably 100 ppb or more, still more preferably 200 ppb or more.
  • the upper limit is not particularly limited, but for example, it is preferably 100,000 ppm, and more preferably 50,000 ppm.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant at the start of polymerization is in the above range, an aqueous dispersion having a smaller average primary particle size and more excellent stability can be obtained.
  • the aspect ratio of the primary particles can be made smaller.
  • the step of continuously adding the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant is the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon when the concentration of PTFE formed in the aqueous medium is 10% by mass or less. It is preferable that the system surfactant is added to the aqueous medium. It is more preferable to start adding the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant when it is 8.0% by mass or less, and further preferably to start adding it when it is 5.0% by mass or less, 4.0% by mass. It is even more preferable to start adding when the concentration is 3.0% by mass or less, particularly preferably when the concentration is 3.0% by mass or less, and particularly preferably to start adding when the concentration is 2.0% by mass or less.
  • the above concentration is the concentration with respect to the total of the aqueous medium and PTFE.
  • the amount of the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant added is 0.01 to 10% by mass with respect to 100% by mass of the aqueous medium. It is preferable to have.
  • a more preferable lower limit is 0.05% by mass, a further preferable lower limit is 0.1% by mass, a more preferable upper limit is 5% by mass, and a further preferable upper limit is 1% by mass.
  • carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant examples include the surfactant (1-0) represented by the general formula (1-0), the surfactant (a) represented by the above formula (a), and the above. Selected from the group consisting of the surfactant (b) represented by the formula (b), the surfactant represented by the formula ( ⁇ ), and the surfactant obtained by radically or oxidizing any of these. At least one type is preferable.
  • the carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant is an aliphatic-type carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant
  • the aliphatic-type carboxylic acid-type hydrocarbon-based surfactant is represented by the formula ( ⁇ ).
  • the polymerization step includes the step (II)
  • the polymerization step includes a step of subjecting the carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon surfactant to the radical treatment or the oxidation treatment.
  • an aqueous dispersion containing the above particles, TFE, an aqueous medium, a modified monomer, a hydrocarbon-based surfactant, and other additives are charged into the polymerization reactor, and the reactor is charged. It can be carried out by stirring the contents of the above, keeping the reactor at a predetermined polymerization temperature, and then adding a predetermined amount of a polymerization initiator to initiate the polymerization reaction. After starting the polymerization reaction, a monomer, a polymerization initiator, a chain transfer agent, the above-mentioned hydrocarbon-based surfactant and the like may be additionally added depending on the purpose.
  • the above-mentioned hydrocarbon-based surfactant may be added after the polymerization reaction has started.
  • the polymerization initiator is not particularly limited as long as it can generate radicals in the above polymerization temperature range, and known oil-soluble and / or water-soluble polymerization initiators can be used. Further, the polymerization can be started as a redox in combination with a reducing agent or the like. The concentration of the polymerization initiator is appropriately determined depending on the type of monomer, the target molecular weight of PTFE, and the reaction rate. As the polymerization initiator, it is preferable to use an oil-soluble radical polymerization initiator or a water-soluble radical polymerization initiator.
  • the step (II) is preferably a step performed in the presence of an oil-soluble radical polymerization initiator or a water-soluble radical polymerization initiator.
  • an oil-soluble peroxide or a water-soluble peroxide described later as the polymerization initiator.
  • step (II) it is preferable that TFE and, if necessary, a modified monomer are polymerized in the absence of a fluorine-containing surfactant.
  • “Substantially in the absence of a fluorine-containing surfactant” means that the amount of the fluorine-containing surfactant is 1 ppm or less with respect to the PTFE obtained by polymerization, and is preferably 100 ppb or less, more preferably. Is 10 ppb or less, more preferably 1 ppb or less.
  • the PTFE powder (for example, PTFE fine powder) obtained by the production method of the present disclosure may be used as a powder, or the powder may be added to water and used as an aqueous dispersion.
  • the obtained PTFE fine powder is preferable for molding, and suitable applications include hydraulic systems such as aircraft and automobiles, fuel system tubes and the like, flexible hoses such as chemicals and steam, electric wire coating applications and the like. ..
  • the obtained PTFE aqueous dispersion is stabilized and further concentrated by adding a nonionic surfactant, and is used for various purposes as a composition to which an organic or inorganic filler is added depending on the purpose. It is also preferable to use it.
  • the above composition has a non-adhesive and low coefficient of friction by coating on a base material made of metal or ceramics, and has excellent gloss, smoothness, abrasion resistance, weather resistance and heat resistance. It is suitable for painting rolls and cooking utensils, impregnating glass cloth, and the like.
  • An organosol of PTFE can also be prepared from the above-mentioned aqueous dispersion of PTFE.
  • the organosol can contain the PTFE and the organic solvent, and the organic solvent includes an ether solvent, a ketone solvent, an alcohol solvent, an amide solvent, an ester solvent, an aliphatic hydrocarbon solvent, and an aromatic solvent. Examples thereof include a hydrocarbon solvent and a halogenated hydrocarbon solvent, and N-methyl-2-pyrrolidone, dimethylacetamide and the like can be preferably used.
  • the preparation of the organosol can be carried out, for example, by the method described in International Publication No. 2012/002038.
  • aqueous dispersion of PTFE or the above-mentioned PTFE fine powder is also preferable to use as a processing aid.
  • a processing aid by mixing the aqueous dispersion or the fine powder with a host polymer or the like, the melt strength during melt processing of the host polymer can be improved, and the mechanical strength, electrical properties, and difficulties of the obtained polymer can be improved. It is possible to improve flammability, drip prevention during combustion, and slidability.
  • the aqueous dispersion of PTFE or the fine powder of PTFE is also preferably used as a binder for batteries and dustproof.
  • the aqueous dispersion of PTFE or the PTFE fine powder is used as a processing aid after being combined with a resin other than PTFE.
  • the aqueous dispersion or the fine powder is, for example, a raw material for PTFE described in JP-A-11-49912, US Pat. No. 5,804,654, JP-A-11-29679, and JP-A-2003-2980. Is suitable as.
  • the processing aid using the aqueous dispersion or the fine powder is not inferior to the processing aids described in the respective publications.
  • the aqueous dispersion of PTFE is mixed with an aqueous dispersion of a melt-processable fluororesin and coagulated to obtain a co-coagulation powder.
  • the co-coagulation powder is suitable as a processing aid.
  • melt-processable fluororesin examples include FEP, PFA, TFE / perfluoroallyl ether copolymer, ETFE, ethylene / TFE / HFP copolymer [EFEP], and FEP is preferable.
  • the aqueous dispersion preferably contains the melt-processable fluororesin.
  • the melt-processable fluororesin include FEP, PFA, TFE / perfluoroallyl ether copolymer, ETFE, EFEP and the like.
  • the aqueous dispersion containing the melt-processable fluororesin can be used as a coating material. Since the melt-processable fluororesin can sufficiently fuse the particles of the TFE polymer to each other, the film-forming property can be improved and the obtained film can be glossed.
  • the fluorine-free resin to which the co-coagulation powder is added may be in the form of a powder, in the form of pellets, or in the form of an emulsion.
  • the above addition is preferably carried out while applying a shearing force by a known method such as extrusion kneading or roll kneading, in that each resin is sufficiently mixed.
  • the use of the aqueous dispersion is not particularly limited, and as the aqueous dispersion is applied as it is, it is coated on a substrate, dried, and then fired as necessary; coating materials such as non-woven fabrics and resin molded products. Impregnation by impregnating the porous support, drying, and then preferably firing; coating on a substrate such as glass, drying, and if necessary, immersing in water to peel off the substrate to form a thin film. Examples thereof include cast film formation to be obtained, and examples of these applications include aqueous dispersion type paints, tent films, conveyor belts, printed substrates (CCL), binders for electrodes, water repellents for electrodes, and the like. ..
  • the aqueous dispersion is obtained by blending a compounding agent such as a known pigment, thickener, dispersant, antifoaming agent, antifreezing agent, or film forming aid, or by further compounding another polymer compound. It can be used as a water-based coating coating. Further, as an additive application, it can be used as a binder for suppressing the falling off of the active material of the electrode, a binder application, a compound application such as an anti-drip agent, and a dust suppression treatment application for preventing the flying of earth and sand and dust.
  • a compounding agent such as a known pigment, thickener, dispersant, antifoaming agent, antifreezing agent, or film forming aid
  • Anionic surfactants can be preferably contained for the purpose of adjusting the viscosity of the aqueous dispersion or for improving the miscibility of pigments, fillers and the like.
  • the anionic surfactant can be appropriately added as long as there is no problem in terms of economy and environment.
  • anionic surfactant examples include non-fluorinated anionic surfactants and fluorine-containing anionic surfactants, but fluorine-free non-fluorinated anionic surfactants, that is, hydrocarbon anionic surfactants. Agents are preferred.
  • the type is not particularly limited as long as it is a known anionic surfactant, but for example, the anionic surfactant described in International Publication No. 2013/146950 and International Publication No. 2013/146947.
  • Agents can be used.
  • those having a saturated or unsaturated aliphatic chain having 6 to 40 carbon atoms, preferably 8 to 20 carbon atoms, and more preferably 9 to 13 carbon atoms can be mentioned.
  • the saturated or unsaturated aliphatic chain may be either a straight chain or a branched chain, and may have a cyclic structure.
  • the hydrocarbon may be aromatic or may have an aromatic group.
  • the hydrocarbon may have heteroatoms such as oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur.
  • anionic surfactant examples include alkyl sulfonate, alkyl sulfate, alkyl aryl sulfate and salts thereof; aliphatic (carboxylic acid) acid and its salt; phosphoric acid alkyl ester, phosphoric acid alkylaryl ester or salt thereof; and the like.
  • alkyl sulfonates, alkyl sulfates, aliphatic carboxylic acids or salts thereof are preferred.
  • alkyl sulfate or a salt thereof ammonium lauryl sulfate, sodium lauryl sulfate and the like are preferable.
  • succinic acid, decanoic acid, undecanoic acid, undecenoic acid, lauric acid, hydrododecanoic acid, or salts thereof are preferable.
  • the amount of the anionic surfactant added depends on the type of the anionic surfactant and other compounding agents, but is preferably 10 ppm to 5000 ppm with respect to the solid content mass of the fluoropolymer. As the lower limit of the amount of the anionic surfactant added, 50 ppm or more is more preferable, and 100 ppm or more is further preferable. If the amount added is too small, the viscosity adjusting effect is poor. The upper limit of the amount of the anionic surfactant added is more preferably 3000 ppm or less, still more preferably 2000 ppm or less. If the amount added is too large, the mechanical stability and storage stability of the aqueous dispersion may be impaired.
  • methyl cellulose, alumina sol, polyvinyl alcohol, carboxylated vinyl polymer and the like can be blended in addition to the anionic surfactant.
  • a pH adjuster such as aqueous ammonia can also be added for the purpose of adjusting the pH of the aqueous dispersion.
  • the aqueous dispersion may contain other water-soluble polymer compounds as long as the characteristics of the aqueous dispersion are not impaired.
  • the other water-soluble polymer compounds are not particularly limited, and for example, polyethylene oxide (dispersion stabilizer), polyethylene glycol (dispersion stabilizer), polyvinylpyrrolidone (dispersion stabilizer), phenol resin, urea resin, epoxy resin, etc. Examples thereof include melamine resin, polyester resin, polyether resin, acrylic silicone resin, silicone resin, silicone polyester resin, and polyurethane resin.
  • preservatives such as isothiazolone-based, azole-based, pronopol, chlorotalonil, methylsulfonyltetrachloropyrodin, carventazim, fluoroforbet, sodium diacetate, and diiodomethyltolylsulfone.
  • the aqueous dispersion of PTFE is also preferably used as a dust control treatment agent.
  • the dust control treatment agent is a method of mixing a dust generating substance and applying a compression-shearing action to the mixture at a temperature of 20 to 200 ° C. to fibrillate the TFE polymer to suppress dust of the dust generating substance.
  • it can be used in methods such as Japanese Patent No. 2827152 and Japanese Patent No. 2538783.
  • the aqueous dispersion of PTFE can be suitably used, for example, in the dust control agent composition described in International Publication No. 2007/004250, and also in the dust control treatment method described in International Publication No. 2007/000812. It can be preferably used.
  • the above-mentioned dust control treatment agents include building materials, soil stabilizers, solidifying materials, fertilizers, incineration ash and harmful substances in landfills, explosion-proof fields, cosmetics fields, sand for pet excretion represented by cat sand, etc. It is suitably used for the dust control treatment of.
  • aqueous dispersion of PTFE as a raw material for obtaining TFE polymer fibers by a dispersion spinning method (Dispersion Spinning method).
  • Dispersion spinning method an aqueous dispersion of the TFE polymer and an aqueous dispersion of a matrix polymer are mixed, and the mixture is extruded to form an intermediate fiber structure, and the intermediate fiber structure is formed.
  • High molecular weight PTFE can also be produced by the production method of the present disclosure.
  • the production method of the present disclosure can produce PTFE having a molecular weight equivalent to that of a production method using a conventional fluorine-containing surfactant without using a conventional fluorine-containing surfactant.
  • the polymerization temperature is preferably 30 ° C. or higher, more preferably 40 ° C. or higher, and even more preferably 50 ° C. or higher. Further, 100 ° C. or lower is preferable, and 95 ° C. or lower is more preferable.
  • the polymerization pressure is preferably 0.5 MPaG or more, preferably 0.7 MPaG or more, preferably 1.0 MPaG or more, preferably 5.0 MPaG or less, more preferably 4.0 MPaG or less, still more preferably 3.0 MPaG or less.
  • the high molecular weight PTFE powder obtained by polymerization has stretchability and non-melt processability, and is also useful as a raw material for a stretched body (porous body).
  • this stretched body is a membrane (PTFE stretched membrane or PTFE porous membrane), it can be stretched by a known PTFE stretching method.
  • the high molecular weight PTFE is easily fibrillated into a PTFE porous body (membrane) composed of nodules and fibers.
  • a uniaxially stretched film can be obtained by roll-stretching a sheet-shaped or rod-shaped paste extruded product in the extrusion direction.
  • a biaxially stretched film can also be obtained by stretching in the width direction with a tenter or the like. It is also preferable to perform a semi-baking treatment before stretching.
  • This PTFE stretched body is a porous body having a high porosity, and is It can be suitably used as a filter medium for various microfiltration filters such as an air filter and a chemical solution filter, and a support material for a polymer electrolyte membrane. It is also useful as a material for products used in the textile field, medical field, electrochemical field, sealing material field, air filtration field, ventilation / internal pressure adjustment field, liquid filtration field, general consumer material field, and the like. Specific uses will be illustrated below.
  • Electrochemical field Dielectric material prepreg EMI shielding material, heat transfer material, etc. More specifically, printed wiring boards, electromagnetic shielding shield materials, insulating heat transfer materials, insulating materials, etc. Sealing material field Gaskets, packings, pump diaphragms, pump tubes, aircraft sealing materials, etc.
  • Air filtration field ULPA filter for semiconductor manufacturing
  • HEPA filter for hospital / semiconductor manufacturing
  • cylindrical cartridge filter for industrial use
  • bug filter for industrial use
  • heat-resistant bag filter- for exhaust gas treatment
  • heat-resistant pleated filter for exhaust gas treatment
  • SINBRAN filter for industrial use
  • catalyst filter for exhaust gas treatment
  • filter with adsorbent built-in HDD
  • vent filter with adsorbent for built-in HDD
  • vent filter for built-in HDD, etc.
  • cleaning Machine filters for vacuum cleaners
  • general-purpose multi-layer felt materials for GT cartridge filters (for GT compatible products), cooling filters (for electronic device housings), etc.
  • Ventilation / internal pressure adjustment field Freezing and drying materials such as containers for freezing and drying, ventilation materials for automobiles for electronic circuits and lamps, container applications such as container caps, electronic devices including small terminals such as tablet terminals and mobile phone terminals For protective ventilation applications, medical ventilation applications, etc.
  • Liquid filtration field Semiconductor liquid filtration filter (for semiconductor manufacturing), hydrophilic PTFE filter (for semiconductor manufacturing), filter for chemicals (for chemical treatment), filter for pure water production line (for pure water production), backwash type liquid Filtration filter (for industrial wastewater treatment), etc.
  • Textile field PTFE fiber fiber material
  • sewing thread textile
  • weaving thread textile
  • rope etc.
  • the production method of the present disclosure can also produce low molecular weight PTFE.
  • the low molecular weight PTFE may be produced by polymerization, or the high molecular weight PTFE obtained by polymerization may be produced by reducing the molecular weight by a known method (pyrolysis, irradiation decomposition, etc.).
  • the polymerization temperature is preferably 30 ° C. or higher, more preferably 40 ° C. or higher, and even more preferably 50 ° C. or higher. Further, 100 ° C. or lower is preferable, 90 ° C. or lower is more preferable, and 80 ° C. or lower is further preferable.
  • the polymerization pressure is preferably 0.3 MPaG or more, preferably 0.4 MPaG or more, preferably 0.5 MPaG or more, preferably 5.0 MPaG or less, more preferably 4.0 MPaG or less, still more preferably 3.0 MPaG or less.
  • Low molecular weight PTFE also called PTFE micropowder
  • PTFE micropowder with a molecular weight of 600,000 or less has excellent chemical stability, extremely low surface energy, and is less likely to cause fibrillation, thus improving slipperiness and the texture of the coating film surface. It is suitable for producing plastics, inks, cosmetics, paints, greases, office automation equipment members, toners and the like as additives for the purpose of making them (see, for example, Japanese Patent Application Laid-Open No. 10-147617).
  • a polymerization initiator and the above-mentioned surfactant are dispersed in an aqueous medium, and TFE or a monomer copolymerizable with TFE is polymerized with TFE to obtain low molecular weight PTFE. You may.
  • the high molecular weight PTFE means a PTFE having non-melt processability and fibrillation property.
  • the low molecular weight PTFE means PTFE having melt processability and not fibrillation property.
  • the non-melt processability means a property that the melt flow rate cannot be measured at a temperature higher than the crystallization melting point in accordance with ASTM D 1238.
  • the high molecular weight PTFE preferably has a standard specific gravity (SSG) of 2.130 to 2.280.
  • the standard specific gravity is measured by a water substitution method based on ASTM D 792 using a sample molded according to ASTM D 4895-89.
  • “high molecular weight” means that the standard specific gravity is within the above range.
  • the low molecular weight PTFE has a melt viscosity at 380 ° C. of 1 ⁇ 10 2 to 7 ⁇ 10 5 Pa ⁇ s.
  • melt viscosity means that the melt viscosity is within the above range.
  • the high molecular weight PTFE has an extremely higher melt viscosity than the low molecular weight PTFE, and it is difficult to accurately measure the melt viscosity.
  • the melt viscosity of the low molecular weight PTFE can be measured, it is difficult to obtain a molded product that can be used for measuring the standard specific gravity from the low molecular weight PTFE, and it is difficult to measure the accurate standard specific gravity. Is. Therefore, in the present disclosure, the standard specific gravity is adopted as an index of the molecular weight of the high molecular weight PTFE, and the melt viscosity is adopted as an index of the molecular weight of the low molecular weight PTFE. There is no known measurement method capable of directly specifying the molecular weight of either the high molecular weight PTFE or the low molecular weight PTFE.
  • the high molecular weight PTFE preferably has a peak temperature of 333 to 347 ° C, more preferably 335 to 345 ° C.
  • the low molecular weight PTFE preferably has a peak temperature of 322 to 333 ° C, more preferably 324 to 332 ° C.
  • the peak temperature corresponds to the maximum value in the heat of fusion curve when the temperature is raised at a rate of 10 ° C./min using a differential scanning calorimeter [DSC] for a PTFE that has no history of heating to a temperature of 300 ° C. or higher. Is.
  • the high molecular weight PTFE is 333 to 347 ° C. in the heat of fusion curve when the temperature is raised at a rate of 10 ° C./min using a differential scanning calorimeter [DSC] for a PTFE having no history of heating to a temperature of 300 ° C. or higher. It is preferable that at least one heat absorption peak appears in the range of 1 and the amount of heat of fusion calculated from the heat of fusion curve at 290 to 350 ° C. is 62 mJ / mg or more.
  • An unfired tape (raw tape) can also be obtained from the PTFE fine powder obtained by using the above-mentioned surfactant.
  • the surfactant, the decomposition products and by-products of the surfactant produced as a by-product from the surfactant, and the residue By recovering and purifying the monomer or the like, the surfactant, a decomposition product or by-product of the surfactant produced as a by-product from the surfactant, a residual monomer, or the like may be reused.
  • the method for recovering and purifying is not particularly limited, but a known method can be used. For example, it can be carried out by the method described in Japanese Patent Publication No. 2011-520020.
  • the polymerization of FEP is preferably carried out at a polymerization temperature of 10 to 150 ° C. and a polymerization pressure of 0.2 to 8.0 MPaG.
  • the polymerization temperature is more preferably 30 ° C. or higher, further preferably 40 ° C. or higher, and even more preferably 50 ° C. or higher.
  • 130 ° C. or lower is more preferable, 120 ° C. or lower is further preferable, 110 ° C. or lower is particularly preferable, and 100 ° C. or lower is even more preferable.
  • the polymerization pressure is preferably 0.5 MPaG or more, preferably 1.0 MPaG or more, preferably 1.2 MPaG or more, more preferably 6.0 MPaG or less, still more preferably 5.0 MPaG or less.
  • the FEP may be further modified by using perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) as the third component within a range of 0.1 to 2% by mass of all the monomers.
  • the surfactant can be used within the range of use in the production method of the present disclosure, but usually, an amount of 0.0001 to 10% by mass is added with respect to 100% by mass of the aqueous medium.
  • FEP polymerization of FEP
  • cyclohexane methanol, ethanol, propanol, ethane, propane, butane, pentane, hexane, carbon tetrachloride, chloroform, methylene chloride, methyl chloride and the like
  • the buffer it is preferable to use ammonium carbonate, disodium hydrogen phosphate or the like.
  • the FEP powder obtained by the production method of the present disclosure may be pelletized by melt extrusion. Further, the melt extrusion can be carried out by appropriately setting the extrusion conditions as long as the extrusion conditions can be generally pelletized.
  • the obtained FEP may have a terminal group such as -CF 3 or -CF 2 H at at least one of the polymer main chain and the polymer side chain.
  • a terminal group such as -CF 3 or -CF 2 H at at least one of the polymer main chain and the polymer side chain.
  • the unstable terminal group is chemically unstable, it not only lowers the heat resistance of the resin but also causes an increase in the amount of attenuation of the obtained electric wire.
  • the polymer at the end of polymerization can be produced so that the total number of unstable terminal groups and -CF 2 H terminal groups is 50 or less per 1 ⁇ 10 6 carbon atoms. preferable. It is more preferably less than 20 per 1 ⁇ 10 6 carbon atoms, and even more preferably 5 or less.
  • the unstable terminal group and the -CF 2 H terminal group may be absent and all may be a -CF 3 terminal group.
  • Unstable end groups and -CF 2 H end groups can be converted to -CF 3 end groups and stabilized by fluorination treatment.
  • the fluorination treatment method is not particularly limited, and examples thereof include a method of exposing the polymer to a fluorine radical source that generates fluorine radicals under fluorination treatment conditions.
  • the fluorine radical source include fluorine gas, CoF 3 , AgF 2 , UF 6 , OF 2 , N 2 F 2 , CF 3 OF, and halogen fluoride, for example, IF 5 , ClF 3 .
  • a method of directly contacting fluorine gas with FEP obtained by the production method of the present disclosure is preferable, and the above contact is performed using diluted fluorine gas having a fluorine gas concentration of 10 to 50% by mass in terms of reaction control.
  • the diluted fluorine gas can be obtained by diluting the fluorine gas with an inert gas such as nitrogen gas or argon gas.
  • the fluorine gas treatment can be performed, for example, at a temperature of 100 to 250 ° C.
  • the processing temperature is not limited to the above range, and can be appropriately set according to the situation.
  • the fluorine gas treatment is preferably carried out by continuously or intermittently supplying diluted fluorine gas into the reactor. This fluorination treatment may be a dry powder after polymerization or pellets extruded by melt.
  • the FEP obtained by the manufacturing method of the present disclosure has good moldability, is less likely to cause molding defects, and has good heat resistance, chemical resistance, solvent resistance, insulation, electrical properties, and the like.
  • the FEP powder obtained by the production method of the present disclosure may be fluorinated.
  • the above-mentioned method for producing a fluorinated powder is a method for obtaining a fluorinated powder by fluorinating the powder obtained by the above-mentioned method for producing a powder by supplying fluorinated gas.
  • the method for producing pellets of FEP is a method for obtaining pellets by pelletizing the FEP obtained by the production method of the present disclosure described above.
  • the pellet may be fluorinated.
  • the above-mentioned method for producing fluorinated pellets is a method for obtaining fluorinated pellets by supplying fluorinated gas to the pellets obtained by the above-mentioned method for producing pellets.
  • this FEP can be used for manufacturing various molded products such as electric wires, foamed electric wires, cables, coating materials such as wires, tubes, films, sheets, filaments and the like.
  • the polymerization of a TFE / perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) copolymer such as PFA or MFA and a TFE / perfluoroallyl ether copolymer is usually carried out at a polymerization temperature of 10 to 130 ° C.
  • the pressure is preferably 0.3 to 6.0 MPaG.
  • the polymerization temperature is more preferably 30 ° C. or higher, further preferably 40 ° C. or higher, and even more preferably 50 ° C. or higher. Further, 120 ° C. or lower is more preferable, 110 ° C.
  • the polymerization pressure is preferably 0.5 MPaG or more, preferably 1.0 MPaG or more, more preferably 5.0 MPaG or less, further preferably 4.0 MPaG or less, and particularly preferably 3.0 MPaG or less.
  • the above-mentioned surfactant can be used within the range of use in the production method of the present disclosure, but is usually used. It is preferable to add in an amount of 0.0001 to 10% by mass based on 100% by mass of the aqueous medium.
  • TFE / perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) copolymer and TFE / perfluoroallyl ether copolymer cyclohexane, methanol, ethanol, propanol, propane, butane, pentane, hexane, carbon tetrachloride, as chain transfer agents, Chloroform, methylene chloride, methyl chloride, methane, ethane and the like are preferably used, and ammonium carbonate, disodium hydrogen phosphate and the like are preferably used as the pH buffer.
  • the powder of the TFE / perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) copolymer such as PFA and MFA and the TFE / perfluoroallyl ether copolymer obtained by the production method of the present disclosure may be pelletized by melt extrusion. Further, the melt extrusion can be carried out by appropriately setting the extrusion conditions as long as the extrusion conditions can be generally pelletized.
  • the above-mentioned copolymer is preferably treated with fluorine gas for the purpose of improving its heat resistance and further enhancing the effect of suppressing chemical permeation of the molded product.
  • Fluorine gas treatment is performed by bringing fluorine gas into contact with a chemical permeation inhibitor. However, since the reaction with fluorine is very exothermic, it is preferable to dilute fluorine with an inert gas such as nitrogen.
  • the amount of fluorine in the fluorine gas / inert gas mixture is 1 to 100% by mass, preferably 10 to 25% by mass.
  • the treatment temperature is 150 to 250 ° C., preferably 200 to 250 ° C., and the fluorine gas treatment time is 3 to 16 hours, preferably 4 to 12 hours.
  • the gas pressure for fluorine gas treatment is in the range of 1 to 10 atm, but atmospheric pressure is preferably used. When the reactor is used at atmospheric pressure, the fluorine gas / inert gas mixture may be continuously passed through the reactor. As a result, unstable end of the copolymer is converted to -CF 3 end, a thermally stable.
  • molding methods such as compression molding, transfer molding, extrusion molding, injection molding, blow molding and the like can be applied as in the case of conventional PFA.
  • a desired molded product can be obtained by such a molding method.
  • the molded product include a sheet, a film, a packing, a round bar, a square bar, a pipe, a tube, a round tank, a square tank, a tank, and a wafer.
  • tubes, pipes, tanks, connectors, etc. used for various chemical reaction devices, semiconductor manufacturing devices, and acid-based or alkaline-based chemical supply devices that require impermeable chemical solutions. Can be used.
  • a nonionic surfactant is appropriately added to the aqueous dispersion of the TFE / perfluoro (alkyl vinyl ether) copolymer such as PFA and MFA and the TFE / perfluoroallyl ether copolymer, and if necessary, poly.
  • a primer composition can be obtained by dissolving or dispersing ether sulfone, polyamideimide and / or polyimide, and a metal powder in an organic solvent. This primer composition is applied to a metal surface, a melt-processable fluororesin composition is applied onto the thus formed primer layer, and the melt-processable fluororesin composition layer is fired together with the primer layer to form fluorine on the metal surface. It can also be used as a resin coating method.
  • the polymerization of ETFE is preferably carried out at a polymerization temperature of 0 to 100 ° C. and a polymerization pressure of 0.1 to 20 MPaG.
  • the polymerization temperature is preferably 20 ° C. or higher, more preferably 30 ° C. or higher, and even more preferably 40 ° C. or higher. Further, 95 ° C. or lower is preferable, 90 ° C. or lower is more preferable, and 80 ° C. or lower is further preferable.
  • the polymerization pressure is preferably 0.5 MPaG or more, more preferably 0.8 MPaG or more, further preferably 1.0 MPaG or more, still more preferably 20 MPaG or less, still more preferably 10 MPaG or less, still more preferably 5 or less.
  • the ETFE may be further modified by using a third monomer in a range of 0 to 20% by mass of all the monomers.
  • TFE: ethylene: third monomer (63 to 94) :( 27 to 2) :( 1 to 10).
  • the third monomer include perfluorobutylethylene, 3,3,4,4,5,5,6,6,7,7,8,8,8-tridecafluoroocta-1-ene, 2,3.
  • the above-mentioned surfactant can be used within the range of use in the production method of the present disclosure, but is usually added in an amount of 0.0001 to 10% by mass with respect to 100% by mass of the aqueous medium. ..
  • cyclohexane methanol, ethanol, propanol, ethane, propane, butane, pentane, hexane, carbon tetrachloride, chloroform, methylene chloride, methyl chloride and the like as the chain transfer agent.
  • the ETFE powder obtained by the production method of the present disclosure may be pelletized by melt extrusion. Further, the melt extrusion can be carried out by appropriately setting the extrusion conditions as long as the extrusion conditions can be generally pelletized.
  • the ETFE sheet can be extruded into a sheet. That is, the ETFE powder or pellet can be melted, continuously extruded from the die, and cooled to obtain a sheet-shaped molded product. Additives may be added to ETFE.
  • the additive a known additive can be appropriately used. Specific examples include ultraviolet absorbers, light stabilizers, antioxidants, infrared absorbers, flame retardants, flame retardant fillers, organic pigments, inorganic pigments, dyes and the like. Inorganic additives are preferable from the viewpoint of excellent weather resistance.
  • the content of the additive in the ETFE sheet is preferably 20% by mass or less, and particularly preferably 10% by mass or less, based on the total mass of the ETFE sheet.
  • membrane materials for membrane structure buildings (athletic facilities, gardening facilities, atriums, etc.) ) Is suitable.
  • membrane materials for membrane structures for example, outdoor board materials (soundproof walls, windbreak fences, overwave fences, garage canopies, shopping malls, pedestrian walls, roofing materials), glass shatterproof films, heat and water resistance Sheets, building materials, etc. (tent materials for tent warehouses, membrane materials for sunshades, partial roofing materials for lighting, window materials that replace glass, membrane materials for flameproof partitions, curtains, exterior wall reinforcement, waterproof membranes, smokeproof membranes, etc.
  • Non-combustible transparent partition road reinforcement, interior (lighting, wall surface, brand, etc.), exterior (tent, signboard, etc.), daily leisure goods (fishing rod, racket, golf club, projection curtain, etc.), automobile materials (roof) , Vibration damping material, body, etc.), aircraft material, ship material, home appliance exterior, tank, container inner wall, filter, construction membrane material, electronic material (printed substrate, wiring substrate, insulating film, release film, etc.), solar cell It is useful as a surface material for modules, a mirror protective material for solar thermal power generation, a surface material for solar water heaters, and the like.
  • An electrolyte polymer precursor can also be produced using the production method of the present disclosure.
  • the polymerization of the electrolyte polymer precursor is preferably carried out at a polymerization temperature of 0 to 100 ° C. and a polymerization pressure of ⁇ 0.05 to 5.0 MPaG.
  • the electrolyte polymer precursor is composed of a vinyl ether monomer as shown below, and can be converted into an ion-exchangeable polymer through a hydrolysis treatment.
  • the polymerization temperature is more preferably 5 ° C. or higher, further preferably 10 ° C. or higher. Further, 80 ° C. or lower is more preferable, and 60 ° C. or lower is further preferable.
  • the polymerization pressure is preferably 0 MPaG or more, preferably 0.02 MPaG or more, more preferably 2.0 MPaG or less, still more preferably 1.0 MPaG or less.
  • CF 2 CF-O- (CF 2 CFY 151- O) n- (CFY 152 ) m- A 151
  • Y 151 represents a fluorine atom, a chlorine atom, a -SO 2 F group or a perfluoroalkyl group.
  • the perfluoroalkyl group may contain etheric oxygen and a -SO 2 F group. , 0 to 3.
  • n Y 151 may be the same or different.
  • Y 152 represents a fluorine atom, a chlorine atom or a -SO 2 F group. M is.
  • Y 152 represents an integer of 1 to 5 may be different or may be the same .
  • a 151 represents the -SO 2 X 151, -COZ 151 or -POZ 152 Z 153.
  • X 151 represents F, Cl, Br, I, -OR 151 or -NR 152 R 153 ;
  • Z 151 , Z 152 and Z 153 represent the same or different, -NR 154 R 155 or -OR 156 .
  • R 151 , R 152 , R 153 , R 154 , R 155 and R 156 represent alkyl, aryl, or sulfonyl-containing groups that may contain H, ammonium, alkali metal, or fluorine atoms, which may be identical or different. ) Can be mentioned.
  • the electrolyte polymer precursor may be modified with a third monomer within a range of 0 to 20% by mass of all the monomers.
  • the third monomer include polyfunctional monomers such as CTFE, vinylidene fluoride, perfluoroalkyl vinyl ether, and divinylbenzene.
  • the electrolyte polymer precursor thus obtained is formed into, for example, a film, hydrolyzed with an alkaline solution, and treated with mineral acid to form a polymer electrolyte film such as a fuel cell, an electrolyzer, and a redox flow battery. Can be used for.
  • the electrolyte polymer dispersion can be obtained by hydrolyzing with an alkaline solution while maintaining the dispersed state of the electrolyte polymer precursor. Subsequently, by heating to 120 ° C. or higher in the pressurized container, it can be dissolved in, for example, a water / alcohol mixed solvent to be in a solution state.
  • the solution thus obtained can be used, for example, as a binder for electrodes, or can be combined with various additives to form a cast film, and can be used, for example, for an antifouling coating film, an organic actuator, or the like.
  • the melt-processable fluororesin powder can be suitably used as a powder coating material.
  • a powder coating material made of the melt-processable fluororesin powder is applied to a base material, a film having a smooth surface can be obtained.
  • the melt-processable fluororesin powder having an average particle size of 1 ⁇ m or more and less than 100 ⁇ m is particularly suitable as a powder coating used for electrostatic coating, and the melt-processable fluororesin powder having an average particle size of 100 ⁇ m or more and 1000 ⁇ m or less is particularly suitable.
  • Especially suitable as a powder coating used for rotary coating or rotary molding is particularly suitable.
  • the melt-processable fluororesin powder can be produced by a method of obtaining a powder by drying and pulverizing the melt-processable fluororesin obtained by the above-described production method of the present disclosure.
  • a production method for producing the melt-processable fluororesin powder is also one of the present disclosures.
  • the method for recovering and purifying the above is not particularly limited, but it can be carried out by a known method. For example, it can be carried out by the method described in Japanese Patent Publication No. 2011-520020.
  • the method for recovering and purifying the monomer and the like is not particularly limited, but a conventionally known method can be adopted.
  • a conventionally known method can be adopted.
  • the surfactant and the like can be desorbed and eluted from the ion exchange resin particles adsorbed by the surfactant and the like by a known method and recovered.
  • a surfactant or the like can be eluted by contacting the mineral acid with the anion exchange resin.
  • a water-soluble organic solvent is added to the subsequently obtained eluate, it is usually separated into two phases. Therefore, the surfactant and the like can be recovered by recovering and neutralizing the lower phase containing the surfactant and the like.
  • the water-soluble organic solvent include polar solvents such as alcohols, ketones, and ethers.
  • Another method for recovering the surfactant or the like from the ion exchange resin particles includes a method using an ammonium salt and a water-soluble organic solvent, and a method using an alcohol and an acid if desired. In the latter method, an ester derivative such as the above-mentioned surfactant is produced, so that it can be easily separated from alcohol by distillation.
  • the wastewater contains fluoropolymer particles or other solids, it is preferable to remove them before contacting the wastewater with the adsorbed particles.
  • the method for removing the fluoropolymer particles and other solids include a method of separating the wastewater and the precipitate after precipitating them by adding an aluminum salt or the like, an electrocoagulation method or the like. Further, it may be removed by a mechanical method, and examples thereof include a cross flow filtration method, a deep layer filtration method, and a precoat filtration method.
  • the concentration of the unaggregated fluoropolymer in the waste water is preferably low from the viewpoint of productivity, more preferably less than 0.4% by mass, and particularly preferably less than 0.3% by mass.
  • a scrubber As a method of recovering the surfactant or the like from the off-gas, a scrubber is used and brought into contact with an organic solvent such as deionized water, an alkaline aqueous solution or a glycol ether solvent to prepare a scrubber solution containing the surfactant or the like. There is a way to get it.
  • an organic solvent such as deionized water, an alkaline aqueous solution or a glycol ether solvent
  • the scrubber solution can be recovered in a state where the surfactant and the like are phase-separated, so that the surfactant and the like can be easily recovered and reused.
  • the alkaline compound include alkali metal hydroxides and quaternary ammonium salts.
  • a reverse osmosis membrane or the like may be used to concentrate the scrubber solution containing the above-mentioned surfactant or the like.
  • the concentrated scrubber solution usually contains fluorine ions, but after concentration, alumina can be further added to remove the fluorine ions, thereby facilitating the reuse of the above-mentioned surfactant and the like.
  • the adsorbed particles may be brought into contact with the scrubber solution to adsorb the surfactant or the like, and the surfactant or the like may be recovered by the method described above.
  • the surfactant or the like recovered by any of the above methods can be reused in the production of the fluoropolymer.
  • the present disclosure also includes a step of removing or reducing the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) by heat-treating the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion containing the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A).
  • a method for producing an aqueous dispersion hereinafter, also referred to as “the third production method of the present disclosure”.
  • the aqueous dispersion After changing the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1) to the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A), the aqueous dispersion is heat-treated to change the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion from the general formula (1A). ) Can be removed or reduced. Further, by recovering the gas containing the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) and water generated by the heat treatment and cooling the recovered gas as necessary, the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) is cooled. An aqueous dispersion containing the compound and water can also be obtained. It is also preferable that the method for producing the aqueous dispersion includes a step of recovering a gas containing the compound represented by the general formula (1A) and water generated by the heat treatment.
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion containing the fluoropolymer and the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A) is, for example, a fluoropolymer obtained by polymerizing a fluoromonomer using the above-mentioned carboxylic acid type hydrocarbon-based surfactant. It can be obtained by adjusting the aqueous dispersion to be acidic. Examples of the method for adjusting the acidity include a method of adding an acid, a method of injecting an acidic gas such as carbon dioxide, sulfur dioxide, sulfur trioxide, and nitrogen dioxide. As the method for adding the acid, the type of acid, and the like, the same methods as those in the first and second production methods of the present disclosure can be adopted. When the polymerized fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion obtained by polymerization is acidic, it is not necessary to perform the operation of adjusting it to acidic.
  • the temperature of the heat treatment is preferably more than 150 ° C. Since the specific fluorine-containing compound can be reduced more efficiently, the temperature of the heat treatment (drying) is preferably 155 ° C or higher, more preferably 160 ° C or higher, further preferably 165 ° C or higher, and even more preferably 170 ° C or higher. 175 ° C. or higher is particularly preferable, and 180 ° C. or higher is particularly preferable.
  • the heat treatment is preferably carried out in the presence of steam.
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is placed in a reaction vessel and heat-treated under the condition that water is vaporized, it can be carried out in the presence of water vapor.
  • the reaction vessel is preferably sealed.
  • the content of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) contained in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is not limited, but is, for example, about 1 ppb to 10000 ppm, preferably 100 ppb or more, with respect to the fluoropolymer. More preferably, it is 1 ppm or more, further preferably 10 ppm or more, and particularly preferably 100 ppm or more.
  • the aqueous dispersion to be subjected to the heat treatment may contain one type of fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A), or may contain two or more types, but two or more types.
  • the third manufacturing method of the present disclosure is particularly effective when it is included.
  • aqueous dispersion to be subjected to the heat treatment includes, as the above-mentioned fluorine-containing compound, a fluorine-containing compound having a general formula (1A) m of 7 or less and a fluorine-containing compound having a general formula (1A) m of 8 or more. It may contain a fluorine-containing compound having m of 8 or less in the general formula (1A) and a fluorine-containing compound having m of 9 or more in the general formula (1A).
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion contains a fluorine-containing compound having m of 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, 13, 15, 17 and 19 among the fluorine-containing compounds included in the general formula (1A). It may be an embodiment that does not contain a fluorine-containing compound in which m is 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 and 18, or m is 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 and 18. And 20 may be included, and m may be 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, 13, 15, 17 and 19 and may not contain a fluorine-containing compound, or m may be 3 to 19. It may be an embodiment including all of the fluorine-containing compounds.
  • the concentration of the fluoropolymer-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is not particularly limited, and a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion having an arbitrary concentration can be treated. it can.
  • the total amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound represented by the above general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, and 0.1 ppm or more, based on the fluoropolymer. It may be 0.5 ppm or more.
  • the total amount may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, 10 ppm or more, or 100 ppm or more with respect to the total amount of water.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A) may have a fluoropolymer-containing compound of 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, and 2000 ppm or less.
  • ppm and ppb mean the values obtained by mass conversion unless otherwise specified.
  • Each of the two amounts may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, 0.5 ppm or more, 1 ppm or more, or 5 ppm or more with respect to the total amount of water. It may be 10 ppm or more, and may be 100 ppm or more.
  • the at least one amount may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, 1000 ppm or less, 500 ppm or less, respectively, with respect to the total amount of water. It may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 3 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 3 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 4 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 4 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 5 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 5 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 6 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 6 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 7 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 7 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 8 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 8 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 9 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 9 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 10 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 10 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 11 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 11 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 12 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 12 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 13 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 13 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 14 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 14 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 15 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 15 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 16 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 16 in the general formula (1A) may be 10000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 17 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 17 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 18 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 18 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less. When the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 19 in the general formula (1A) may be 0.01 ppm or more, 0.1 ppm or more, or 0.5 ppm or more with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 1 ppm or more, 5 ppm or more, and 10 ppm or more.
  • concentration of the fluoropolymer compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion of the fluoropolymer is above a certain level as described above, the third production method of the present disclosure exhibits higher removal efficiency.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer having m of 19 in the general formula (1A) may be 10,000 ppm or less, 5000 ppm or less, 2000 ppm or less, and 1000 ppm or less with respect to the fluoropolymer. It may be 500 ppm or less, and may be 200 ppm or less.
  • the amount of the fluoropolymer-containing compound in the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is in the above range, the removal efficiency can be further improved.
  • the above fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is a salt of a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) (preferably, a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1), in which M 1 is used in the general formula (1).
  • a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1) preferably, a fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1), in which M 1 is used in the general formula (1).
  • metal atom, NR 5 4 (R 5 may be the same or different, H, or an organic group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms), which may have a substituent imidazolium, substituted It is preferable that it is substantially free of pyridinium (which may be a fluorine-containing compound which is a phosphonium which may have a substituent).
  • the fact that the aqueous dispersion does not substantially contain the salt of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) means that the content of the salt of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) is the same for all m. , 500 ppb or less.
  • the salt of the fluorine-containing compound having m of 3 in the general formula (1A) may be 400 ppb
  • the salt of the fluorine-containing compound having m of 9 may be 400 ppb or less
  • the fluorine-containing compound having m of 3 to 19 may be contained.
  • the total amount of salts of the compounds may be 500 ppb or less.
  • the salt content of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) may be 500 ppb or less, 400 ppb or less, 300 ppb or less, 200 ppb or less, respectively, for all m. It may be 100 ppb or less, 50 ppb or less, and 10 ppb or less.
  • the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion contains a fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A), water, and a fluoropolymer.
  • a fluoropolymer represented by the general formula (1A), water, and a fluoropolymer.
  • the fluoropolymer all the fluoropolymers described in the above-mentioned method for producing a fluoropolymer powder can be adopted.
  • the fluoropolymer a fluororesin having a fluorine substitution rate of 50% or more is preferable, and polytetrafluoroethylene is more preferable.
  • the heat treatment is preferably performed when the concentration of the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the aqueous dispersion is 1 ppb to 1000000 ppm.
  • concentration of the fluorine-containing compound is in the above range, the fluorine-containing compound represented by the general formula (1A) in the obtained aqueous dispersion can be removed or reduced.
  • the solid content concentration of the fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion is not limited, but may be, for example, 1.0 to 70% by mass.
  • the solid content concentration is preferably 8.0% by mass or more, more preferably 10.0% by mass or more, and more preferably 60.0% by mass or less, more preferably 50.0% by mass or less.
  • the solid content concentration is preferably 10 to 25% by mass, preferably 10 to 22% by mass, and more preferably 10 to 20% by mass.
  • the above-mentioned production method may include a step of adding water to a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion to dilute it. For example, by the above dilution, the solid content concentration can be diluted to be 10 to 25% by mass.
  • Formula (1) ( H- (CF 2 ) m -COO) p M 1 (wherein, m is 3 ⁇ 19, M 1 is, H, a metal atom, NR 5 4, have a substituent It may be imidazolium, pyridinium which may have a substituent, or phosphonium which may have a substituent.
  • the content of the compound represented by the general formula (1) of the number of carbon atoms (m + 1) in the extract was calculated using the formula (3).
  • a and b of the formula (3) were obtained from the formula (1).
  • XCm ((ACmb) / a) x ((50 x m + 45) / 413) (3)
  • XCm Content of the compound represented by the general formula (1) of the number of carbon atoms (m + 1) in the extraction solution (ng / mL)
  • ACm Peak area of the compound represented by the general formula (1) of the number of carbon atoms (m + 1) in the extraction solution The quantification limit in this measurement is 1 ng / mL.
  • the content of the compound represented by the general formula (2) having n carbon atoms in the extract was calculated using the formula (3).
  • a and b of the formula (3) were obtained from the formula (1).
  • XSn ((ASn-b) / a) x ((50 x n + 81) / 499) (3)
  • XSn Content of the compound represented by the general formula (2) having n carbon atoms in the extraction solution (ng / mL)
  • Asn Peak area of the compound represented by the general formula (2) of n carbon atoms in the extraction solution The quantification limit in this measurement is 1 ng / mL.
  • ZSn XSn ⁇ 86.3 (5)
  • ZSn Content of the compound represented by the general formula (2) having n carbon atoms contained in the aqueous dispersion (against fluoropolymer)
  • Average primary particle size Measured by dynamic light scattering.
  • a fluoropolymer aqueous dispersion having a fluoropolymer solid content concentration adjusted to about 1.0% by mass was prepared, and measured using ELSZ-1000S (manufactured by Otsuka Electronics Co., Ltd.) at 25 ° C. for a total of 70 times.
  • the refractive index of the solvent (water) was 1.3328, and the viscosity of the solvent (water) was 0.8878 mPa ⁇ s.
  • Solid content concentration of PTFE aqueous dispersion 1 g of PTFE aqueous dispersion is dried in a blower dryer at 150 ° C. for 60 minutes, and the ratio of the mass of the heating residue to the mass (1 g) of the aqueous dispersion is a percentage. Use the value represented by.
  • Synthesis example 1 658.0 g of deionized water and 35.0 g of sodium laurate were added to a reactor with a stirrer having an internal volume of 1 L, the reactor was sealed, the inside of the system was replaced with nitrogen, and oxygen was removed. The temperature of the reactor is raised to 90 ° C., and the pressure is raised to 0.4 MPaG with nitrogen. 6.90 g of ammonium persulfate (APS) was charged and stirred for 3 hours. Stirring was stopped, the reactor was decompressed to atmospheric pressure, and cooled. Ammonia aqueous solution was gradually added to the obtained surfactant aqueous solution with stirring to obtain a surfactant aqueous solution A whose pH was adjusted to 8.5. The sodium laurate concentration at this time was 4.75% by mass.
  • APS ammonium persulfate
  • Synthesis example 2 1780 g of deionized water, 90 g of paraffin wax, and 0.270 g of sodium laurate were added to an autoclave made of SUS having an internal volume of 3 L, the reactor was sealed, the inside of the system was replaced with nitrogen, and oxygen was removed. The temperature of the reactor was raised to 85 ° C., 7.0 g of HFP was added, and the pressure was further increased by TFE to 2.70 MPaG. An aqueous polymerization initiator solution prepared by dissolving 0.310 g of ammonium persulfate (APS) in 20 g of pure water was charged into the reactor. TFE was charged so that the reaction pressure was constant at 2.70 MPaG.
  • APS ammonium persulfate
  • the aqueous dispersion was taken out from the reactor, cooled, and then the paraffin wax was separated.
  • the average primary particle size contained in the obtained PTFE aqueous dispersion was 189 nm.
  • the solid content concentration of the obtained PTFE aqueous dispersion was 26.8% by mass.
  • the pH of the obtained aqueous PTFE dispersion was 6.0.
  • the content of the compounds represented by the general formulas (1) and (2) was measured for the PTFE aqueous dispersion at this time. The results are shown in Table 7.
  • Example 1 Deionized water was added to the PTFE aqueous dispersion obtained in Synthesis Example 2 to adjust the specific gravity (25 ° C.) to 1.080.
  • 2.5 L of a specific gravity-adjusted PTFE aqueous dispersion was added to a coagulation tank having an internal volume of 6 L and provided with a stirring blade and a baffle plate.
  • 16 g of nitric acid (10%) was added to adjust the pH to 1.8, and at the same time, stirring was started at a stirring speed of 500 rpm. After the start of stirring, it was confirmed that the aqueous dispersion was in a slurry state to form a wet PTFE powder, and stirring was continued for another 1 minute.
  • the wet PTFE powder is filtered off, the wet PTFE powder and 2.5 L of deionized water are charged into the coagulation tank, adjusted to 25 ° C., and the operation of washing the polymer powder at a stirring speed of 500 rpm is repeated twice. It was. After washing, the wet PTFE powder was separated and allowed to stand in a hot air circulation type dryer at 210 ° C. for 18 hours to dry to obtain a PTFE powder.
  • the salt content of the compound represented by the general formula (1) contained in the obtained wet PTFE powder was measured using an ion chromatograph, it was less than the quantification limit (10 ppb).
  • the standard specific gravity of the obtained PTFE powder was 2.198.
  • the content of the compounds represented by the general formulas (1) and (2) of the obtained PTFE powder was measured. The results are shown in Table 7.
  • Synthesis example 3 Add 3560 g of deionized degassed water, 180 g of paraffin wax, and 0.54 g of sodium laurate to an autoclave made of SUS with an internal volume of 6 L, seal the reactor, replace the inside of the system with nitrogen, and remove oxygen. It was. The temperature of the reactor was raised to 70 ° C., and TFE was filled in the reactor to bring the reactor to 2.76 MPaG.
  • a polymerization initiator an aqueous solution prepared by dissolving 0.62 g of ammonium persulfate (APS) in 20 g of water and an aqueous solution prepared by dissolving 1.488 g of disuccinic acid peroxide (DSP) in 20 g of water were charged into the reactor.
  • APS ammonium persulfate
  • DSP disuccinic acid peroxide
  • TFE was charged so that the reaction pressure was constant at 2.76 MPaG.
  • stirring was stopped and decompression was performed until the reactor reached atmospheric pressure.
  • the aqueous dispersion was taken out from the reactor, cooled, and then the paraffin wax was separated.
  • the average primary particle diameter of the particles contained in the obtained PTFE aqueous dispersion was 157 nm.
  • the solid content of the obtained PTFE aqueous dispersion was 8.9% by mass.
  • the pH of the obtained aqueous PTFE dispersion was 5.3.
  • Comparative Example 1 Use the PTFE aqueous dispersion obtained in Synthesis Example 3, adjust the specific gravity of the PTFE aqueous dispersion obtained in Synthesis Example 3 to 1.050, coagulate without using nitric acid, and dry temperature.
  • a PTFE powder was obtained in the same manner as in Example 1 except that the temperature was set to 150 ° C.
  • the standard specific gravity of the obtained PTFE was 2.184.
  • the content of the compounds represented by the general formulas (1) and (2) of the obtained PTFE powder was measured. The results are shown in Table 7.
  • Comparative Example 2 Except for using the PTFE aqueous dispersion obtained in Synthesis Example 3, adjusting the specific gravity of the PTFE aqueous dispersion obtained in Synthesis Example 3 to 1.050, and coagulating without using nitric acid.
  • PTFE powder was obtained in the same manner as in Example 1. The content of the compounds represented by the general formulas (1) and (2) of the obtained PTFE powder was measured. The results are shown in Table 7.
  • the quantification limit of the aqueous dispersion was 86 ppb / PTFE, and the quantification limit of the powder was 13 ppb / PTFE.

Landscapes

  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Polymers & Plastics (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Dispersion Chemistry (AREA)
  • Addition Polymer Or Copolymer, Post-Treatments, Or Chemical Modifications (AREA)
  • Polymerisation Methods In General (AREA)
  • Processes Of Treating Macromolecular Substances (AREA)
PCT/JP2020/016766 2019-04-16 2020-04-16 フルオロポリマー粉末の製造方法 Ceased WO2020213691A1 (ja)

Priority Applications (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
EP20791021.7A EP3957656A4 (en) 2019-04-16 2020-04-16 PROCESS FOR PRODUCTION OF FLUOROPOLYMER POWDER
JP2021514226A JPWO2020213691A1 (ja) 2019-04-16 2020-04-16 フルオロポリマー粉末の製造方法
US17/602,448 US12503560B2 (en) 2019-04-16 2020-04-16 Method for producing fluoropolymer powder
CN202080027617.6A CN113661184A (zh) 2019-04-16 2020-04-16 含氟聚合物粉末的制造方法
JP2023062221A JP2023085494A (ja) 2019-04-16 2023-04-06 フルオロポリマー粉末の製造方法

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP2019-077976 2019-04-16
JP2019077976 2019-04-16

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2020213691A1 true WO2020213691A1 (ja) 2020-10-22

Family

ID=72837290

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/JP2020/016766 Ceased WO2020213691A1 (ja) 2019-04-16 2020-04-16 フルオロポリマー粉末の製造方法

Country Status (5)

Country Link
US (1) US12503560B2 (https=)
EP (1) EP3957656A4 (https=)
JP (2) JPWO2020213691A1 (https=)
CN (1) CN113661184A (https=)
WO (1) WO2020213691A1 (https=)

Cited By (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2023204125A1 (ja) * 2022-04-18 2023-10-26 ダイキン工業株式会社 精製ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末の製造方法及び低分子量ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末
WO2024024891A1 (ja) * 2022-07-27 2024-02-01 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマー水性分散液の製造方法、フルオロポリマー水性分散液および塗料組成物
WO2025127122A1 (ja) * 2023-12-12 2025-06-19 ダイキン工業株式会社 テトラフルオロエチレン系ポリマー組成物、電気化学デバイス用バインダー、電極合剤、電極、及び、二次電池
WO2025187825A1 (ja) * 2024-03-07 2025-09-12 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマーの製造方法

Families Citing this family (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2024154803A1 (ja) * 2023-01-18 2024-07-25 ダイキン工業株式会社 テトラフルオロエチレン系ポリマー組成物、電気化学デバイス用バインダー、電極合剤、電極、及び、二次電池
WO2024154805A1 (ja) * 2023-01-18 2024-07-25 ダイキン工業株式会社 テトラフルオロエチレン系ポリマー組成物、固体二次電池用バインダー、電解質層用合剤、電極合剤、電極、及び、固体二次電池

Citations (49)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3250808A (en) 1963-10-31 1966-05-10 Du Pont Fluorocarbon ethers derived from hexafluoropropylene epoxide
US3271341A (en) 1961-08-07 1966-09-06 Du Pont Aqueous colloidal dispersions of polymer
US3391099A (en) 1966-04-25 1968-07-02 Du Pont Polymerization process
JP2538783B2 (ja) 1987-09-24 1996-10-02 村樫石灰工業 株式会社 防塵処理剤組成物
JPH10147617A (ja) 1996-09-18 1998-06-02 Daikin Ind Ltd ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末及びその製造方法
US5804654A (en) 1995-04-28 1998-09-08 General Electric Company Tetrafluoroethylene-containing powder, process for making same, articles molded therefrom and compositions containing such powder
JP2827152B2 (ja) 1994-07-11 1998-11-18 村樫石灰工業株式会社 塵埃抑制方法
JPH1129679A (ja) 1996-07-31 1999-02-02 Mitsubishi Rayon Co Ltd ポリテトラフルオロエチレン含有混合粉体、その製造方法、それを含む熱可塑性樹脂組成物およびその成形体
JPH1149912A (ja) 1997-04-17 1999-02-23 General Electric Co <Ge> 水性フルオロポリマー分散物およびフルオロポリマー含有熱可塑性樹脂組成物の製造方法
WO1999062858A1 (de) 1998-06-02 1999-12-09 Dyneon Gmbh & Co. Kg Verfahren zur rückgewinnung von fluorierten alkansäuren aus abwässern
JP2003002980A (ja) 2001-06-20 2003-01-08 Mitsubishi Rayon Co Ltd ポリテトラフルオロエチレン含有粉体の製造方法
WO2003020836A1 (en) 2001-09-05 2003-03-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluoropolymer dispersion containing no or little low molecular weight fluorinated surfactant
JP2003082019A (ja) * 2001-07-26 2003-03-19 Ausimont Spa 熱加工性テトラフルオロエチレン共重合体の精製方法
JP2003119204A (ja) 2001-10-05 2003-04-23 Daikin Ind Ltd 含フッ素重合体ラテックスの製造方法
WO2004078836A1 (en) 2003-02-28 2004-09-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluoropolymer dispersion containing no or little low molecular weight fluorinated surfactant
US6841616B2 (en) 2003-03-28 2005-01-11 Arkema Inc. Polymerization of halogen-containing monomers using siloxane surfactant
US6841594B2 (en) 2002-01-04 2005-01-11 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Core-shell fluoropolymer dispersions
WO2005042593A1 (ja) 2003-10-31 2005-05-12 Daikin Industries, Ltd. 含フッ素重合体水性分散体の製造方法及び含フッ素重合体水性分散体
JP2005527652A (ja) 2002-01-04 2005-09-15 イー・アイ・デュポン・ドウ・ヌムール・アンド・カンパニー 濃縮フルオロポリマー分散液
WO2006054612A1 (ja) 2004-11-16 2006-05-26 Daikin Industries, Ltd. 変性ポリテトラフルオロエチレンファインパウダー及び変性ポリテトラフルオロエチレン成形体
WO2007000812A1 (ja) 2005-06-29 2007-01-04 Nippo Corporation 塵埃抑制処理方法
WO2007004250A1 (ja) 2005-06-29 2007-01-11 Du Pont-Mitsui Fluorochemicals Co., Ltd. 塵埃処理剤組成物
US20070015866A1 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-01-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous emulsion polymerization of fluorinated monomers using a fluorinated surfactant
US20070015865A1 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-01-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous emulsion polymerization of fluorinated monomers using a perfluoropolyether surfactant
US20070015864A1 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-01-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of making fluoropolymer dispersion
WO2007015937A1 (en) 2005-07-27 2007-02-08 Cantabria Group Lcc Phosphorytated glucomannan polysaccharides containing 1-6 and 1-2 linkages increase weight gain in swine
WO2007046345A1 (ja) 2005-10-17 2007-04-26 Asahi Glass Company, Limited ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性乳化液、それから得られるポリテトラフルオロエチレンファインパウダーおよび多孔体
WO2007046482A1 (ja) 2005-10-20 2007-04-26 Asahi Glass Company, Limited ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性分散液およびその製品
WO2007046377A1 (ja) 2005-10-20 2007-04-26 Asahi Glass Company, Limited 溶融成形可能なフッ素樹脂の製造方法
WO2007049517A1 (ja) * 2005-10-26 2007-05-03 Asahi Glass Company, Limited 含フッ素乳化剤の残留量が少ないフッ素樹脂およびその製造方法
US20070117914A1 (en) 2005-11-24 2007-05-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluorinated surfactants for use in making a fluoropolymer
US20070142541A1 (en) 2005-12-21 2007-06-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluorinated surfactants for making fluoropolymers
WO2007119526A1 (ja) 2006-04-14 2007-10-25 Bridgestone Corporation インラインヒータ及びその製造方法
US20070276103A1 (en) 2006-05-25 2007-11-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluorinated Surfactants
US20080015319A1 (en) 2006-07-13 2008-01-17 Klaus Hintzer Explosion taming surfactants for the production of perfluoropolymers
WO2008060461A1 (en) 2006-11-09 2008-05-22 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Aqueous polymerization of fluorinated monomer using polymerization agent comprising fluoropolyether acid or salt and short chain fluorosurfactant
JP2011520020A (ja) 2008-05-09 2011-07-14 イー・アイ・デュポン・ドウ・ヌムール・アンド・カンパニー フルオロポリマー樹脂の製造に使用するフルオロエーテルカルボン酸またはその塩の削減
JP2011252054A (ja) * 2010-06-01 2011-12-15 Asahi Glass Co Ltd 含フッ素ポリマー水性分散液の製造方法および含フッ素ポリマー水性分散液
WO2012002038A1 (ja) 2010-06-30 2012-01-05 ダイキン工業株式会社 含フッ素重合体のオルガノゾル組成物
WO2013027850A1 (ja) 2011-08-25 2013-02-28 ダイキン工業株式会社 ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性分散液の製造方法
WO2013146947A1 (ja) 2012-03-27 2013-10-03 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマー水性分散液
WO2013146950A1 (ja) 2012-03-30 2013-10-03 ダイキン工業株式会社 非イオン性界面活性剤組成物、及び、フルオロポリマー水性分散液
WO2013189826A1 (en) 2012-06-20 2013-12-27 Solvay Specialty Polymers Italy S.P.A. Tetrafluoroethylene copolymers
WO2013189824A1 (en) 2012-06-20 2013-12-27 Solvay Specialty Polymers Italy S.P.A. Tetrafluoroethylene copolymers
WO2014084399A1 (ja) 2012-11-30 2014-06-05 ダイキン工業株式会社 ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性分散液及びポリテトラフルオロエチレンファインパウダー
US20140228531A1 (en) 2008-07-08 2014-08-14 Solvay Solexis S.P.A. Method for manufacturing fluoropolymers
JP2015516029A (ja) 2012-05-09 2015-06-04 イー・アイ・デュポン・ドウ・ヌムール・アンド・カンパニーE.I.Du Pont De Nemours And Company 変色を低減するための酸化剤を利用するフッ素化ポリマー樹脂処理
WO2019031617A1 (ja) * 2017-08-10 2019-02-14 ダイキン工業株式会社 精製ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性分散液の製造方法、改質ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末の製造方法、ポリテトラフルオロエチレン成形体の製造方法、及び、組成物
WO2019172382A1 (ja) * 2018-03-07 2019-09-12 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマーの製造方法

Family Cites Families (10)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JPH075744B2 (ja) 1990-05-14 1995-01-25 ダイキン工業株式会社 ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末の製法
JP2010229164A (ja) 2007-07-24 2010-10-14 Daikin Ind Ltd フルオロポリマーの製造方法
EP2205646B1 (en) * 2007-10-22 2011-04-13 Solvay Solexis S.p.A. Process for preparing fine dried powders of melt-processable or non-melt-processable tfe (co)polymers
JP2009235070A (ja) 2008-03-07 2009-10-15 Daikin Ind Ltd フルオロエーテルカルボン酸エステル及びフルオロエーテルカルボン酸の製造方法
CN102066307A (zh) 2008-06-24 2011-05-18 旭硝子株式会社 含氟化合物的精制方法
CN103201300B (zh) * 2010-11-09 2016-11-09 纳幕尔杜邦公司 使用烃表面活性剂的含氟单体的含水聚合
CN103210003B (zh) 2010-11-09 2016-09-07 纳幕尔杜邦公司 减弱含烃表面活性剂在含氟单体含水分散体聚合反应中的调聚性能
CN113717300B (zh) 2017-03-31 2023-11-17 大金工业株式会社 含氟聚合物的制造方法、聚合用表面活性剂和表面活性剂的使用
SG11202000862YA (en) 2017-08-10 2020-02-27 Daikin Ind Ltd Method for producing purified polytetrafluoroethylene aqueous dispersion liquid, method for producing modified polytetrafluoroethylene powder, method for producing polytetrafluoroethylene molded body, and composition
US11634514B2 (en) 2018-02-08 2023-04-25 Daikin Industries. Ltd. Method for manufacturing fluoropolymer, surfactant for polymerization, use for surfactant, and composition

Patent Citations (51)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3271341A (en) 1961-08-07 1966-09-06 Du Pont Aqueous colloidal dispersions of polymer
US3250808A (en) 1963-10-31 1966-05-10 Du Pont Fluorocarbon ethers derived from hexafluoropropylene epoxide
US3391099A (en) 1966-04-25 1968-07-02 Du Pont Polymerization process
JP2538783B2 (ja) 1987-09-24 1996-10-02 村樫石灰工業 株式会社 防塵処理剤組成物
JP2827152B2 (ja) 1994-07-11 1998-11-18 村樫石灰工業株式会社 塵埃抑制方法
US5804654A (en) 1995-04-28 1998-09-08 General Electric Company Tetrafluoroethylene-containing powder, process for making same, articles molded therefrom and compositions containing such powder
JPH1129679A (ja) 1996-07-31 1999-02-02 Mitsubishi Rayon Co Ltd ポリテトラフルオロエチレン含有混合粉体、その製造方法、それを含む熱可塑性樹脂組成物およびその成形体
JPH10147617A (ja) 1996-09-18 1998-06-02 Daikin Ind Ltd ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末及びその製造方法
JPH1149912A (ja) 1997-04-17 1999-02-23 General Electric Co <Ge> 水性フルオロポリマー分散物およびフルオロポリマー含有熱可塑性樹脂組成物の製造方法
WO1999062858A1 (de) 1998-06-02 1999-12-09 Dyneon Gmbh & Co. Kg Verfahren zur rückgewinnung von fluorierten alkansäuren aus abwässern
JP2003002980A (ja) 2001-06-20 2003-01-08 Mitsubishi Rayon Co Ltd ポリテトラフルオロエチレン含有粉体の製造方法
JP2003082019A (ja) * 2001-07-26 2003-03-19 Ausimont Spa 熱加工性テトラフルオロエチレン共重合体の精製方法
WO2003020836A1 (en) 2001-09-05 2003-03-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluoropolymer dispersion containing no or little low molecular weight fluorinated surfactant
JP2003119204A (ja) 2001-10-05 2003-04-23 Daikin Ind Ltd 含フッ素重合体ラテックスの製造方法
US6841594B2 (en) 2002-01-04 2005-01-11 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Core-shell fluoropolymer dispersions
JP2005527652A (ja) 2002-01-04 2005-09-15 イー・アイ・デュポン・ドウ・ヌムール・アンド・カンパニー 濃縮フルオロポリマー分散液
WO2004078836A1 (en) 2003-02-28 2004-09-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluoropolymer dispersion containing no or little low molecular weight fluorinated surfactant
US6841616B2 (en) 2003-03-28 2005-01-11 Arkema Inc. Polymerization of halogen-containing monomers using siloxane surfactant
WO2005042593A1 (ja) 2003-10-31 2005-05-12 Daikin Industries, Ltd. 含フッ素重合体水性分散体の製造方法及び含フッ素重合体水性分散体
WO2006054612A1 (ja) 2004-11-16 2006-05-26 Daikin Industries, Ltd. 変性ポリテトラフルオロエチレンファインパウダー及び変性ポリテトラフルオロエチレン成形体
WO2007000812A1 (ja) 2005-06-29 2007-01-04 Nippo Corporation 塵埃抑制処理方法
WO2007004250A1 (ja) 2005-06-29 2007-01-11 Du Pont-Mitsui Fluorochemicals Co., Ltd. 塵埃処理剤組成物
US20070015864A1 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-01-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of making fluoropolymer dispersion
US20070015865A1 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-01-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous emulsion polymerization of fluorinated monomers using a perfluoropolyether surfactant
US20070015866A1 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-01-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous emulsion polymerization of fluorinated monomers using a fluorinated surfactant
US20070027251A1 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-02-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of removing fluorinated carboxylic acid from aqueous liquid
US20070025902A1 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-02-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Recovery of fluorinated carboxylic acid from adsorbent particles
WO2007015937A1 (en) 2005-07-27 2007-02-08 Cantabria Group Lcc Phosphorytated glucomannan polysaccharides containing 1-6 and 1-2 linkages increase weight gain in swine
WO2007046345A1 (ja) 2005-10-17 2007-04-26 Asahi Glass Company, Limited ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性乳化液、それから得られるポリテトラフルオロエチレンファインパウダーおよび多孔体
WO2007046482A1 (ja) 2005-10-20 2007-04-26 Asahi Glass Company, Limited ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性分散液およびその製品
WO2007046377A1 (ja) 2005-10-20 2007-04-26 Asahi Glass Company, Limited 溶融成形可能なフッ素樹脂の製造方法
WO2007049517A1 (ja) * 2005-10-26 2007-05-03 Asahi Glass Company, Limited 含フッ素乳化剤の残留量が少ないフッ素樹脂およびその製造方法
US20070117914A1 (en) 2005-11-24 2007-05-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluorinated surfactants for use in making a fluoropolymer
US20070142541A1 (en) 2005-12-21 2007-06-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluorinated surfactants for making fluoropolymers
WO2007119526A1 (ja) 2006-04-14 2007-10-25 Bridgestone Corporation インラインヒータ及びその製造方法
US20070276103A1 (en) 2006-05-25 2007-11-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Fluorinated Surfactants
US20080015319A1 (en) 2006-07-13 2008-01-17 Klaus Hintzer Explosion taming surfactants for the production of perfluoropolymers
WO2008060461A1 (en) 2006-11-09 2008-05-22 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Aqueous polymerization of fluorinated monomer using polymerization agent comprising fluoropolyether acid or salt and short chain fluorosurfactant
JP2011520020A (ja) 2008-05-09 2011-07-14 イー・アイ・デュポン・ドウ・ヌムール・アンド・カンパニー フルオロポリマー樹脂の製造に使用するフルオロエーテルカルボン酸またはその塩の削減
US20140228531A1 (en) 2008-07-08 2014-08-14 Solvay Solexis S.P.A. Method for manufacturing fluoropolymers
JP2011252054A (ja) * 2010-06-01 2011-12-15 Asahi Glass Co Ltd 含フッ素ポリマー水性分散液の製造方法および含フッ素ポリマー水性分散液
WO2012002038A1 (ja) 2010-06-30 2012-01-05 ダイキン工業株式会社 含フッ素重合体のオルガノゾル組成物
WO2013027850A1 (ja) 2011-08-25 2013-02-28 ダイキン工業株式会社 ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性分散液の製造方法
WO2013146947A1 (ja) 2012-03-27 2013-10-03 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマー水性分散液
WO2013146950A1 (ja) 2012-03-30 2013-10-03 ダイキン工業株式会社 非イオン性界面活性剤組成物、及び、フルオロポリマー水性分散液
JP2015516029A (ja) 2012-05-09 2015-06-04 イー・アイ・デュポン・ドウ・ヌムール・アンド・カンパニーE.I.Du Pont De Nemours And Company 変色を低減するための酸化剤を利用するフッ素化ポリマー樹脂処理
WO2013189826A1 (en) 2012-06-20 2013-12-27 Solvay Specialty Polymers Italy S.P.A. Tetrafluoroethylene copolymers
WO2013189824A1 (en) 2012-06-20 2013-12-27 Solvay Specialty Polymers Italy S.P.A. Tetrafluoroethylene copolymers
WO2014084399A1 (ja) 2012-11-30 2014-06-05 ダイキン工業株式会社 ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性分散液及びポリテトラフルオロエチレンファインパウダー
WO2019031617A1 (ja) * 2017-08-10 2019-02-14 ダイキン工業株式会社 精製ポリテトラフルオロエチレン水性分散液の製造方法、改質ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末の製造方法、ポリテトラフルオロエチレン成形体の製造方法、及び、組成物
WO2019172382A1 (ja) * 2018-03-07 2019-09-12 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマーの製造方法

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
J. APPL. POLYMER SCI., vol. 57, 1995, pages 797

Cited By (10)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2023204125A1 (ja) * 2022-04-18 2023-10-26 ダイキン工業株式会社 精製ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末の製造方法及び低分子量ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末
JP2023158519A (ja) * 2022-04-18 2023-10-30 ダイキン工業株式会社 精製ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末の製造方法及び低分子量ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末
JP7385150B2 (ja) 2022-04-18 2023-11-22 ダイキン工業株式会社 精製ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末の製造方法及び低分子量ポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末
WO2024024891A1 (ja) * 2022-07-27 2024-02-01 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマー水性分散液の製造方法、フルオロポリマー水性分散液および塗料組成物
JPWO2024024891A1 (https=) * 2022-07-27 2024-02-01
WO2025127122A1 (ja) * 2023-12-12 2025-06-19 ダイキン工業株式会社 テトラフルオロエチレン系ポリマー組成物、電気化学デバイス用バインダー、電極合剤、電極、及び、二次電池
JP2025093907A (ja) * 2023-12-12 2025-06-24 ダイキン工業株式会社 テトラフルオロエチレン系ポリマー組成物、電気化学デバイス用バインダー、電極合剤、電極、及び、二次電池
JP7799216B2 (ja) 2023-12-12 2026-01-15 ダイキン工業株式会社 テトラフルオロエチレン系ポリマー組成物、電気化学デバイス用バインダー、電極合剤、電極、及び、二次電池
WO2025187825A1 (ja) * 2024-03-07 2025-09-12 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマーの製造方法
JP2025137487A (ja) * 2024-03-07 2025-09-19 ダイキン工業株式会社 フルオロポリマーの製造方法

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
JPWO2020213691A1 (ja) 2021-11-25
US12503560B2 (en) 2025-12-23
US20220315713A1 (en) 2022-10-06
EP3957656A1 (en) 2022-02-23
CN113661184A (zh) 2021-11-16
JP2023085494A (ja) 2023-06-20
EP3957656A4 (en) 2022-12-28

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
JP7623608B2 (ja) フルオロポリマーの製造方法
WO2020213691A1 (ja) フルオロポリマー粉末の製造方法
JPWO2019172382A1 (ja) フルオロポリマーの製造方法
JP7518435B2 (ja) フルオロポリマー水性分散液の製造方法及びフルオロポリマー水性分散液
WO2021100836A1 (ja) フルオロポリマーの製造方法、ポリテトラフルオロエチレンの製造方法、パーフルオロエラストマーの製造方法および組成物
JP7560758B2 (ja) フルオロポリマーの製造方法、ポリテトラフルオロエチレン組成物及びポリテトラフルオロエチレン粉末
WO2020218620A1 (ja) フルオロポリマー水性分散液の製造方法、排水の処理方法、及び、フルオロポリマー水性分散液
WO2022191286A1 (ja) フルオロポリマー水性分散液の製造方法
JP6989792B2 (ja) フルオロポリマーの製造方法
JPWO2020162512A1 (ja) テトラフルオロエチレン重合体の製造方法及び組成物
JP7747987B2 (ja) フルオロポリマー組成物の製造方法およびフルオロポリマー組成物
JP2025188104A (ja) フルオロポリマーの製造方法
JP2025161847A (ja) 高純度フルオロポリマー含有組成物の製造方法および高純度フルオロポリマー含有組成物
JP7564452B2 (ja) フルオロポリマー水性分散液の製造方法
JP7801633B2 (ja) フッ素樹脂を含有する組成物の製造方法およびフッ素樹脂を含有する組成物
JP7648942B2 (ja) フッ素樹脂の製造方法、フッ素樹脂および水性分散液
RU2831039C2 (ru) Способ производства фторполимера, фторполимер и жидкая водная дисперсия
WO2024248144A1 (ja) フルオロポリマー水性分散液の製造方法およびフルオロポリマー水性分散液

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 20791021

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2021514226

Country of ref document: JP

Kind code of ref document: A

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2020791021

Country of ref document: EP

Effective date: 20211116